Fix wrong overhang display for gstring compositions (Bug#12364).
[bpt/emacs.git] / src / xterm.c
1 /* X Communication module for terminals which understand the X protocol.
2
3 Copyright (C) 1989, 1993-2012 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4
5 This file is part of GNU Emacs.
6
7 GNU Emacs is free software: you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the License, or
10 (at your option) any later version.
11
12 GNU Emacs is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
16
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with GNU Emacs. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
19
20 /* New display code by Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org>. */
21 /* Xt features made by Fred Pierresteguy. */
22
23 #include <config.h>
24 #include <stdio.h>
25 #include <setjmp.h>
26
27 #ifdef HAVE_X_WINDOWS
28
29 #include "lisp.h"
30 #include "blockinput.h"
31 #include "syssignal.h"
32
33 /* This may include sys/types.h, and that somehow loses
34 if this is not done before the other system files. */
35 #include "xterm.h"
36 #include <X11/cursorfont.h>
37
38 /* Load sys/types.h if not already loaded.
39 In some systems loading it twice is suicidal. */
40 #ifndef makedev
41 #include <sys/types.h>
42 #endif /* makedev */
43
44 #include <sys/ioctl.h>
45
46 #include "systime.h"
47
48 #include <fcntl.h>
49 #include <errno.h>
50 #include <setjmp.h>
51 #include <sys/stat.h>
52 /* Caused redefinition of DBL_DIG on Netbsd; seems not to be needed. */
53 /* #include <sys/param.h> */
54
55 #include "charset.h"
56 #include "character.h"
57 #include "coding.h"
58 #include "frame.h"
59 #include "dispextern.h"
60 #include "fontset.h"
61 #include "termhooks.h"
62 #include "termopts.h"
63 #include "termchar.h"
64 #include "emacs-icon.h"
65 #include "disptab.h"
66 #include "buffer.h"
67 #include "window.h"
68 #include "keyboard.h"
69 #include "intervals.h"
70 #include "process.h"
71 #include "atimer.h"
72 #include "keymap.h"
73 #include "font.h"
74 #include "fontset.h"
75 #include "xsettings.h"
76 #include "xgselect.h"
77 #include "sysselect.h"
78
79 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
80 #include <X11/Shell.h>
81 #endif
82
83 #include <unistd.h>
84
85 #ifdef USE_GTK
86 #include "gtkutil.h"
87 #ifdef HAVE_GTK3
88 #include <X11/Xproto.h>
89 #endif
90 #endif
91
92 #ifdef USE_LUCID
93 #include "../lwlib/xlwmenu.h"
94 #endif
95
96 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
97 #if !defined (NO_EDITRES)
98 #define HACK_EDITRES
99 extern void _XEditResCheckMessages (Widget, XtPointer, XEvent *, Boolean *);
100 #endif /* not NO_EDITRES */
101
102 /* Include toolkit specific headers for the scroll bar widget. */
103
104 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
105 #if defined USE_MOTIF
106 #include <Xm/Xm.h> /* for LESSTIF_VERSION */
107 #include <Xm/ScrollBar.h>
108 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
109
110 #ifdef HAVE_XAW3D
111 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Simple.h>
112 #include <X11/Xaw3d/Scrollbar.h>
113 #include <X11/Xaw3d/ThreeD.h>
114 #else /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
115 #include <X11/Xaw/Simple.h>
116 #include <X11/Xaw/Scrollbar.h>
117 #endif /* !HAVE_XAW3D */
118 #ifndef XtNpickTop
119 #define XtNpickTop "pickTop"
120 #endif /* !XtNpickTop */
121 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
122 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
123
124 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
125
126 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
127 #include "widget.h"
128 #ifndef XtNinitialState
129 #define XtNinitialState "initialState"
130 #endif
131 #endif
132
133 #include "bitmaps/gray.xbm"
134
135 /* Default to using XIM if available. */
136 #ifdef USE_XIM
137 int use_xim = 1;
138 #else
139 int use_xim = 0; /* configure --without-xim */
140 #endif
141
142 \f
143
144 /* Non-zero means that a HELP_EVENT has been generated since Emacs
145 start. */
146
147 static int any_help_event_p;
148
149 /* Last window where we saw the mouse. Used by mouse-autoselect-window. */
150 static Lisp_Object last_window;
151
152 /* This is a chain of structures for all the X displays currently in
153 use. */
154
155 struct x_display_info *x_display_list;
156
157 /* This is a list of cons cells, each of the form (NAME
158 . FONT-LIST-CACHE), one for each element of x_display_list and in
159 the same order. NAME is the name of the frame. FONT-LIST-CACHE
160 records previous values returned by x-list-fonts. */
161
162 Lisp_Object x_display_name_list;
163
164 /* This is a frame waiting to be auto-raised, within XTread_socket. */
165
166 static struct frame *pending_autoraise_frame;
167
168 /* This is a frame waiting for an event matching mask, within XTread_socket. */
169
170 static struct {
171 struct frame *f;
172 int eventtype;
173 } pending_event_wait;
174
175 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
176 /* The application context for Xt use. */
177 XtAppContext Xt_app_con;
178 static String Xt_default_resources[] = {0};
179
180 /* Non-zero means user is interacting with a toolkit scroll bar. */
181
182 static int toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction;
183 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
184
185 /* Non-zero timeout value means ignore next mouse click if it arrives
186 before that timeout elapses (i.e. as part of the same sequence of
187 events resulting from clicking on a frame to select it). */
188
189 static unsigned long ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout;
190
191 /* Mouse movement.
192
193 Formerly, we used PointerMotionHintMask (in standard_event_mask)
194 so that we would have to call XQueryPointer after each MotionNotify
195 event to ask for another such event. However, this made mouse tracking
196 slow, and there was a bug that made it eventually stop.
197
198 Simply asking for MotionNotify all the time seems to work better.
199
200 In order to avoid asking for motion events and then throwing most
201 of them away or busy-polling the server for mouse positions, we ask
202 the server for pointer motion hints. This means that we get only
203 one event per group of mouse movements. "Groups" are delimited by
204 other kinds of events (focus changes and button clicks, for
205 example), or by XQueryPointer calls; when one of these happens, we
206 get another MotionNotify event the next time the mouse moves. This
207 is at least as efficient as getting motion events when mouse
208 tracking is on, and I suspect only negligibly worse when tracking
209 is off. */
210
211 /* Where the mouse was last time we reported a mouse event. */
212
213 static XRectangle last_mouse_glyph;
214 static FRAME_PTR last_mouse_glyph_frame;
215 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_press_frame;
216
217 /* The scroll bar in which the last X motion event occurred.
218
219 If the last X motion event occurred in a scroll bar, we set this so
220 XTmouse_position can know whether to report a scroll bar motion or
221 an ordinary motion.
222
223 If the last X motion event didn't occur in a scroll bar, we set
224 this to Qnil, to tell XTmouse_position to return an ordinary motion
225 event. */
226
227 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_scroll_bar;
228
229 /* This is a hack. We would really prefer that XTmouse_position would
230 return the time associated with the position it returns, but there
231 doesn't seem to be any way to wrest the time-stamp from the server
232 along with the position query. So, we just keep track of the time
233 of the last movement we received, and return that in hopes that
234 it's somewhat accurate. */
235
236 static Time last_mouse_movement_time;
237
238 /* Time for last user interaction as returned in X events. */
239
240 static Time last_user_time;
241
242 /* Incremented by XTread_socket whenever it really tries to read
243 events. */
244
245 static int volatile input_signal_count;
246
247 /* Used locally within XTread_socket. */
248
249 static int x_noop_count;
250
251 static Lisp_Object Qalt, Qhyper, Qmeta, Qsuper, Qmodifier_value;
252
253 static Lisp_Object Qvendor_specific_keysyms;
254 static Lisp_Object Qlatin_1;
255
256 #ifdef USE_GTK
257 /* The name of the Emacs icon file. */
258 static Lisp_Object xg_default_icon_file;
259
260 /* Used in gtkutil.c. */
261 Lisp_Object Qx_gtk_map_stock;
262 #endif
263
264 /* Some functions take this as char *, not const char *. */
265 static char emacs_class[] = EMACS_CLASS;
266
267 enum xembed_info
268 {
269 XEMBED_MAPPED = 1 << 0
270 };
271
272 enum xembed_message
273 {
274 XEMBED_EMBEDDED_NOTIFY = 0,
275 XEMBED_WINDOW_ACTIVATE = 1,
276 XEMBED_WINDOW_DEACTIVATE = 2,
277 XEMBED_REQUEST_FOCUS = 3,
278 XEMBED_FOCUS_IN = 4,
279 XEMBED_FOCUS_OUT = 5,
280 XEMBED_FOCUS_NEXT = 6,
281 XEMBED_FOCUS_PREV = 7,
282
283 XEMBED_MODALITY_ON = 10,
284 XEMBED_MODALITY_OFF = 11,
285 XEMBED_REGISTER_ACCELERATOR = 12,
286 XEMBED_UNREGISTER_ACCELERATOR = 13,
287 XEMBED_ACTIVATE_ACCELERATOR = 14
288 };
289
290 /* Used in x_flush. */
291
292 static int x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (Display *, Colormap, XColor *);
293 static void x_set_window_size_1 (struct frame *, int, int, int);
294 static void x_raise_frame (struct frame *);
295 static void x_lower_frame (struct frame *);
296 static const XColor *x_color_cells (Display *, int *);
297 static void x_update_window_end (struct window *, int, int);
298
299 static int x_io_error_quitter (Display *);
300 static struct terminal *x_create_terminal (struct x_display_info *);
301 void x_delete_terminal (struct terminal *);
302 static void x_update_end (struct frame *);
303 static void XTframe_up_to_date (struct frame *);
304 static void XTset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *);
305 static void XTreset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *);
306 static void x_clear_frame (struct frame *);
307 static _Noreturn void x_ins_del_lines (struct frame *, int, int);
308 static void frame_highlight (struct frame *);
309 static void frame_unhighlight (struct frame *);
310 static void x_new_focus_frame (struct x_display_info *, struct frame *);
311 static void x_focus_changed (int, int, struct x_display_info *,
312 struct frame *, struct input_event *);
313 static void x_detect_focus_change (struct x_display_info *,
314 XEvent *, struct input_event *);
315 static void XTframe_rehighlight (struct frame *);
316 static void x_frame_rehighlight (struct x_display_info *);
317 static void x_draw_hollow_cursor (struct window *, struct glyph_row *);
318 static void x_draw_bar_cursor (struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int,
319 enum text_cursor_kinds);
320
321 static void x_clip_to_row (struct window *, struct glyph_row *, int, GC);
322 static void x_flush (struct frame *f);
323 static void x_update_begin (struct frame *);
324 static void x_update_window_begin (struct window *);
325 static void x_after_update_window_line (struct glyph_row *);
326 static struct scroll_bar *x_window_to_scroll_bar (Display *, Window);
327 static void x_scroll_bar_report_motion (struct frame **, Lisp_Object *,
328 enum scroll_bar_part *,
329 Lisp_Object *, Lisp_Object *,
330 Time *);
331 static int x_handle_net_wm_state (struct frame *, XPropertyEvent *);
332 static void x_check_fullscreen (struct frame *);
333 static void x_check_expected_move (struct frame *, int, int);
334 static void x_sync_with_move (struct frame *, int, int, int);
335 static int handle_one_xevent (struct x_display_info *, XEvent *,
336 int *, struct input_event *);
337 #ifdef USE_GTK
338 static int x_dispatch_event (XEvent *, Display *);
339 #endif
340 /* Don't declare this _Noreturn because we want no
341 interference with debugging failing X calls. */
342 static void x_connection_closed (Display *, const char *);
343 static void x_wm_set_window_state (struct frame *, int);
344 static void x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (struct frame *, ptrdiff_t);
345 static void x_initialize (void);
346
347
348 /* Flush display of frame F, or of all frames if F is null. */
349
350 static void
351 x_flush (struct frame *f)
352 {
353 /* Don't call XFlush when it is not safe to redisplay; the X
354 connection may be broken. */
355 if (!NILP (Vinhibit_redisplay))
356 return;
357
358 BLOCK_INPUT;
359 if (f == NULL)
360 {
361 Lisp_Object rest, frame;
362 FOR_EACH_FRAME (rest, frame)
363 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame)))
364 x_flush (XFRAME (frame));
365 }
366 else if (FRAME_X_P (f))
367 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
368 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
369 }
370
371
372 /* Remove calls to XFlush by defining XFlush to an empty replacement.
373 Calls to XFlush should be unnecessary because the X output buffer
374 is flushed automatically as needed by calls to XPending,
375 XNextEvent, or XWindowEvent according to the XFlush man page.
376 XTread_socket calls XPending. Removing XFlush improves
377 performance. */
378
379 #define XFlush(DISPLAY) (void) 0
380
381 \f
382 /***********************************************************************
383 Debugging
384 ***********************************************************************/
385
386 #if 0
387
388 /* This is a function useful for recording debugging information about
389 the sequence of occurrences in this file. */
390
391 struct record
392 {
393 char *locus;
394 int type;
395 };
396
397 struct record event_record[100];
398
399 int event_record_index;
400
401 void
402 record_event (char *locus, int type)
403 {
404 if (event_record_index == sizeof (event_record) / sizeof (struct record))
405 event_record_index = 0;
406
407 event_record[event_record_index].locus = locus;
408 event_record[event_record_index].type = type;
409 event_record_index++;
410 }
411
412 #endif /* 0 */
413
414
415 \f
416 /* Return the struct x_display_info corresponding to DPY. */
417
418 struct x_display_info *
419 x_display_info_for_display (Display *dpy)
420 {
421 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
422
423 for (dpyinfo = x_display_list; dpyinfo; dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next)
424 if (dpyinfo->display == dpy)
425 return dpyinfo;
426
427 return 0;
428 }
429
430 static Window
431 x_find_topmost_parent (struct frame *f)
432 {
433 struct x_output *x = f->output_data.x;
434 Window win = None, wi = x->parent_desc;
435 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
436
437 while (wi != FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window)
438 {
439 Window root;
440 Window *children;
441 unsigned int nchildren;
442
443 win = wi;
444 XQueryTree (dpy, win, &root, &wi, &children, &nchildren);
445 XFree (children);
446 }
447
448 return win;
449 }
450
451 #define OPAQUE 0xffffffff
452
453 void
454 x_set_frame_alpha (struct frame *f)
455 {
456 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
457 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
458 Window win = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
459 double alpha = 1.0;
460 double alpha_min = 1.0;
461 unsigned long opac;
462 Window parent;
463
464 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame == f)
465 alpha = f->alpha[0];
466 else
467 alpha = f->alpha[1];
468
469 if (FLOATP (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit))
470 alpha_min = XFLOAT_DATA (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit);
471 else if (INTEGERP (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit))
472 alpha_min = (XINT (Vframe_alpha_lower_limit)) / 100.0;
473
474 if (alpha < 0.0)
475 return;
476 else if (alpha > 1.0)
477 alpha = 1.0;
478 else if (0.0 <= alpha && alpha < alpha_min && alpha_min <= 1.0)
479 alpha = alpha_min;
480
481 opac = alpha * OPAQUE;
482
483 x_catch_errors (dpy);
484
485 /* If there is a parent from the window manager, put the property there
486 also, to work around broken window managers that fail to do that.
487 Do this unconditionally as this function is called on reparent when
488 alpha has not changed on the frame. */
489
490 parent = x_find_topmost_parent (f);
491 if (parent != None)
492 XChangeProperty (dpy, parent, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity,
493 XA_CARDINAL, 32, PropModeReplace,
494 (unsigned char *) &opac, 1L);
495
496 /* return unless necessary */
497 {
498 unsigned char *data;
499 Atom actual;
500 int rc, format;
501 unsigned long n, left;
502
503 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, win, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity,
504 0L, 1L, False, XA_CARDINAL,
505 &actual, &format, &n, &left,
506 &data);
507
508 if (rc == Success && actual != None)
509 {
510 unsigned long value = *(unsigned long *)data;
511 XFree (data);
512 if (value == opac)
513 {
514 x_uncatch_errors ();
515 return;
516 }
517 }
518 }
519
520 XChangeProperty (dpy, win, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity,
521 XA_CARDINAL, 32, PropModeReplace,
522 (unsigned char *) &opac, 1L);
523 x_uncatch_errors ();
524 }
525
526 int
527 x_display_pixel_height (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
528 {
529 return HeightOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
530 }
531
532 int
533 x_display_pixel_width (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
534 {
535 return WidthOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
536 }
537
538 \f
539 /***********************************************************************
540 Starting and ending an update
541 ***********************************************************************/
542
543 /* Start an update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook
544 for update_begin, i.e. it is called when update_begin is called.
545 This function is called prior to calls to x_update_window_begin for
546 each window being updated. Currently, there is nothing to do here
547 because all interesting stuff is done on a window basis. */
548
549 static void
550 x_update_begin (struct frame *f)
551 {
552 /* Nothing to do. */
553 }
554
555
556 /* Start update of window W. Set the global variable updated_window
557 to the window being updated and set output_cursor to the cursor
558 position of W. */
559
560 static void
561 x_update_window_begin (struct window *w)
562 {
563 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
564 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
565
566 updated_window = w;
567 set_output_cursor (&w->cursor);
568
569 BLOCK_INPUT;
570
571 if (f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
572 {
573 /* Don't do highlighting for mouse motion during the update. */
574 hlinfo->mouse_face_defer = 1;
575
576 /* If F needs to be redrawn, simply forget about any prior mouse
577 highlighting. */
578 if (FRAME_GARBAGED_P (f))
579 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
580 }
581
582 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
583 }
584
585
586 /* Draw a vertical window border from (x,y0) to (x,y1) */
587
588 static void
589 x_draw_vertical_window_border (struct window *w, int x, int y0, int y1)
590 {
591 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
592 struct face *face;
593
594 face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, VERTICAL_BORDER_FACE_ID);
595 if (face)
596 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
597 face->foreground);
598
599 XDrawLine (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
600 f->output_data.x->normal_gc, x, y0, x, y1);
601 }
602
603 /* End update of window W (which is equal to updated_window).
604
605 Draw vertical borders between horizontally adjacent windows, and
606 display W's cursor if CURSOR_ON_P is non-zero.
607
608 MOUSE_FACE_OVERWRITTEN_P non-zero means that some row containing
609 glyphs in mouse-face were overwritten. In that case we have to
610 make sure that the mouse-highlight is properly redrawn.
611
612 W may be a menu bar pseudo-window in case we don't have X toolkit
613 support. Such windows don't have a cursor, so don't display it
614 here. */
615
616 static void
617 x_update_window_end (struct window *w, int cursor_on_p, int mouse_face_overwritten_p)
618 {
619 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (XFRAME (w->frame));
620
621 if (!w->pseudo_window_p)
622 {
623 BLOCK_INPUT;
624
625 if (cursor_on_p)
626 display_and_set_cursor (w, 1, output_cursor.hpos,
627 output_cursor.vpos,
628 output_cursor.x, output_cursor.y);
629
630 if (draw_window_fringes (w, 1))
631 x_draw_vertical_border (w);
632
633 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
634 }
635
636 /* If a row with mouse-face was overwritten, arrange for
637 XTframe_up_to_date to redisplay the mouse highlight. */
638 if (mouse_face_overwritten_p)
639 {
640 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
641 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
642 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
643 }
644
645 updated_window = NULL;
646 }
647
648
649 /* End update of frame F. This function is installed as a hook in
650 update_end. */
651
652 static void
653 x_update_end (struct frame *f)
654 {
655 /* Mouse highlight may be displayed again. */
656 MOUSE_HL_INFO (f)->mouse_face_defer = 0;
657
658 #ifndef XFlush
659 BLOCK_INPUT;
660 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
661 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
662 #endif
663 }
664
665
666 /* This function is called from various places in xdisp.c whenever a
667 complete update has been performed. The global variable
668 updated_window is not available here. */
669
670 static void
671 XTframe_up_to_date (struct frame *f)
672 {
673 if (FRAME_X_P (f))
674 {
675 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = MOUSE_HL_INFO (f);
676
677 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc
678 || f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
679 {
680 BLOCK_INPUT;
681 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
682 note_mouse_highlight (hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame,
683 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x,
684 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y);
685 hlinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
686 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
687 }
688 }
689 }
690
691
692 /* Draw truncation mark bitmaps, continuation mark bitmaps, overlay
693 arrow bitmaps, or clear the fringes if no bitmaps are required
694 before DESIRED_ROW is made current. The window being updated is
695 found in updated_window. This function It is called from
696 update_window_line only if it is known that there are differences
697 between bitmaps to be drawn between current row and DESIRED_ROW. */
698
699 static void
700 x_after_update_window_line (struct glyph_row *desired_row)
701 {
702 struct window *w = updated_window;
703 struct frame *f;
704 int width, height;
705
706 eassert (w);
707
708 if (!desired_row->mode_line_p && !w->pseudo_window_p)
709 desired_row->redraw_fringe_bitmaps_p = 1;
710
711 /* When a window has disappeared, make sure that no rest of
712 full-width rows stays visible in the internal border. Could
713 check here if updated_window is the leftmost/rightmost window,
714 but I guess it's not worth doing since vertically split windows
715 are almost never used, internal border is rarely set, and the
716 overhead is very small. */
717 if (windows_or_buffers_changed
718 && desired_row->full_width_p
719 && (f = XFRAME (w->frame),
720 width = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
721 width != 0)
722 && (height = desired_row->visible_height,
723 height > 0))
724 {
725 int y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, desired_row->y));
726
727 BLOCK_INPUT;
728 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
729 0, y, width, height, False);
730 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
731 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - width,
732 y, width, height, False);
733 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
734 }
735 }
736
737 static void
738 x_draw_fringe_bitmap (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, struct draw_fringe_bitmap_params *p)
739 {
740 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
741 Display *display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
742 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
743 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
744 struct face *face = p->face;
745
746 /* Must clip because of partially visible lines. */
747 x_clip_to_row (w, row, -1, gc);
748
749 if (!p->overlay_p)
750 {
751 int bx = p->bx, by = p->by, nx = p->nx, ny = p->ny;
752
753 /* In case the same realized face is used for fringes and
754 for something displayed in the text (e.g. face `region' on
755 mono-displays, the fill style may have been changed to
756 FillSolid in x_draw_glyph_string_background. */
757 if (face->stipple)
758 XSetFillStyle (display, face->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
759 else
760 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->background);
761
762 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
763 /* If the fringe is adjacent to the left (right) scroll bar of a
764 leftmost (rightmost, respectively) window, then extend its
765 background to the gap between the fringe and the bar. */
766 if ((WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
767 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
768 || (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
769 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w)))
770 {
771 int sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
772
773 if (sb_width > 0)
774 {
775 int bar_area_x = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
776 int bar_area_width = (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w)
777 * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f));
778
779 if (bx < 0)
780 {
781 /* Bitmap fills the fringe. */
782 if (bar_area_x + bar_area_width == p->x)
783 bx = bar_area_x + sb_width;
784 else if (p->x + p->wd == bar_area_x)
785 bx = bar_area_x;
786 if (bx >= 0)
787 {
788 int header_line_height = WINDOW_HEADER_LINE_HEIGHT (w);
789
790 nx = bar_area_width - sb_width;
791 by = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (header_line_height,
792 row->y));
793 ny = row->visible_height;
794 }
795 }
796 else
797 {
798 if (bar_area_x + bar_area_width == bx)
799 {
800 bx = bar_area_x + sb_width;
801 nx += bar_area_width - sb_width;
802 }
803 else if (bx + nx == bar_area_x)
804 nx += bar_area_width - sb_width;
805 }
806 }
807 }
808 #endif
809 if (bx >= 0 && nx > 0)
810 XFillRectangle (display, window, face->gc, bx, by, nx, ny);
811
812 if (!face->stipple)
813 XSetForeground (display, face->gc, face->foreground);
814 }
815
816 if (p->which)
817 {
818 char *bits;
819 Pixmap pixmap, clipmask = (Pixmap) 0;
820 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f));
821 XGCValues gcv;
822
823 if (p->wd > 8)
824 bits = (char *) (p->bits + p->dh);
825 else
826 bits = (char *) p->bits + p->dh;
827
828 /* Draw the bitmap. I believe these small pixmaps can be cached
829 by the server. */
830 pixmap = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display, window, bits, p->wd, p->h,
831 (p->cursor_p
832 ? (p->overlay_p ? face->background
833 : f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
834 : face->foreground),
835 face->background, depth);
836
837 if (p->overlay_p)
838 {
839 clipmask = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (display,
840 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window,
841 bits, p->wd, p->h,
842 1, 0, 1);
843 gcv.clip_mask = clipmask;
844 gcv.clip_x_origin = p->x;
845 gcv.clip_y_origin = p->y;
846 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin, &gcv);
847 }
848
849 XCopyArea (display, pixmap, window, gc, 0, 0,
850 p->wd, p->h, p->x, p->y);
851 XFreePixmap (display, pixmap);
852
853 if (p->overlay_p)
854 {
855 gcv.clip_mask = (Pixmap) 0;
856 XChangeGC (display, gc, GCClipMask, &gcv);
857 XFreePixmap (display, clipmask);
858 }
859 }
860
861 XSetClipMask (display, gc, None);
862 }
863
864 \f
865
866 /* This is called when starting Emacs and when restarting after
867 suspend. When starting Emacs, no X window is mapped. And nothing
868 must be done to Emacs's own window if it is suspended (though that
869 rarely happens). */
870
871 static void
872 XTset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *terminal)
873 {
874 }
875
876 /* This is called when exiting or suspending Emacs. Exiting will make
877 the X-windows go away, and suspending requires no action. */
878
879 static void
880 XTreset_terminal_modes (struct terminal *terminal)
881 {
882 }
883
884 \f
885 /***********************************************************************
886 Glyph display
887 ***********************************************************************/
888
889
890
891 static void x_set_glyph_string_clipping (struct glyph_string *);
892 static void x_set_glyph_string_gc (struct glyph_string *);
893 static void x_draw_glyph_string_background (struct glyph_string *,
894 int);
895 static void x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *);
896 static void x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *);
897 static void x_draw_glyph_string_box (struct glyph_string *);
898 static void x_draw_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *);
899 static _Noreturn void x_delete_glyphs (struct frame *, int);
900 static void x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (struct glyph_string *);
901 static void x_set_cursor_gc (struct glyph_string *);
902 static void x_set_mode_line_face_gc (struct glyph_string *);
903 static void x_set_mouse_face_gc (struct glyph_string *);
904 static int x_alloc_lighter_color (struct frame *, Display *, Colormap,
905 unsigned long *, double, int);
906 static void x_setup_relief_color (struct frame *, struct relief *,
907 double, int, unsigned long);
908 static void x_setup_relief_colors (struct glyph_string *);
909 static void x_draw_image_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *);
910 static void x_draw_image_relief (struct glyph_string *);
911 static void x_draw_image_foreground (struct glyph_string *);
912 static void x_draw_image_foreground_1 (struct glyph_string *, Pixmap);
913 static void x_clear_glyph_string_rect (struct glyph_string *, int,
914 int, int, int);
915 static void x_draw_relief_rect (struct frame *, int, int, int, int,
916 int, int, int, int, int, int,
917 XRectangle *);
918 static void x_draw_box_rect (struct glyph_string *, int, int, int, int,
919 int, int, int, XRectangle *);
920 static void x_scroll_bar_clear (struct frame *);
921
922 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
923 static void x_check_font (struct frame *, struct font *);
924 #endif
925
926
927 /* Set S->gc to a suitable GC for drawing glyph string S in cursor
928 face. */
929
930 static void
931 x_set_cursor_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
932 {
933 if (s->font == FRAME_FONT (s->f)
934 && s->face->background == FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
935 && s->face->foreground == FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (s->f)
936 && !s->cmp)
937 s->gc = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_gc;
938 else
939 {
940 /* Cursor on non-default face: must merge. */
941 XGCValues xgcv;
942 unsigned long mask;
943
944 xgcv.background = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
945 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
946
947 /* If the glyph would be invisible, try a different foreground. */
948 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
949 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
950 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
951 xgcv.foreground = s->f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel;
952 if (xgcv.foreground == xgcv.background)
953 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
954
955 /* Make sure the cursor is distinct from text in this face. */
956 if (xgcv.background == s->face->background
957 && xgcv.foreground == s->face->foreground)
958 {
959 xgcv.background = s->face->foreground;
960 xgcv.foreground = s->face->background;
961 }
962
963 IF_DEBUG (x_check_font (s->f, s->font));
964 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
965 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
966
967 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
968 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
969 mask, &xgcv);
970 else
971 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
972 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
973
974 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
975 }
976 }
977
978
979 /* Set up S->gc of glyph string S for drawing text in mouse face. */
980
981 static void
982 x_set_mouse_face_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
983 {
984 int face_id;
985 struct face *face;
986
987 /* What face has to be used last for the mouse face? */
988 face_id = MOUSE_HL_INFO (s->f)->mouse_face_face_id;
989 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
990 if (face == NULL)
991 face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, MOUSE_FACE_ID);
992
993 if (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
994 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, s->first_glyph->u.ch, -1, Qnil);
995 else
996 face_id = FACE_FOR_CHAR (s->f, face, 0, -1, Qnil);
997 s->face = FACE_FROM_ID (s->f, face_id);
998 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
999
1000 if (s->font == s->face->font)
1001 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1002 else
1003 {
1004 /* Otherwise construct scratch_cursor_gc with values from FACE
1005 except for FONT. */
1006 XGCValues xgcv;
1007 unsigned long mask;
1008
1009 xgcv.background = s->face->background;
1010 xgcv.foreground = s->face->foreground;
1011 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1012 mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
1013
1014 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc)
1015 XChangeGC (s->display, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc,
1016 mask, &xgcv);
1017 else
1018 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc
1019 = XCreateGC (s->display, s->window, mask, &xgcv);
1020
1021 s->gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (s->f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
1022
1023 }
1024 eassert (s->gc != 0);
1025 }
1026
1027
1028 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S to a GC suitable for drawing a mode line.
1029 Faces to use in the mode line have already been computed when the
1030 matrix was built, so there isn't much to do, here. */
1031
1032 static inline void
1033 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
1034 {
1035 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1036 }
1037
1038
1039 /* Set S->gc of glyph string S for drawing that glyph string. Set
1040 S->stippled_p to a non-zero value if the face of S has a stipple
1041 pattern. */
1042
1043 static inline void
1044 x_set_glyph_string_gc (struct glyph_string *s)
1045 {
1046 PREPARE_FACE_FOR_DISPLAY (s->f, s->face);
1047
1048 if (s->hl == DRAW_NORMAL_TEXT)
1049 {
1050 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1051 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1052 }
1053 else if (s->hl == DRAW_INVERSE_VIDEO)
1054 {
1055 x_set_mode_line_face_gc (s);
1056 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1057 }
1058 else if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
1059 {
1060 x_set_cursor_gc (s);
1061 s->stippled_p = 0;
1062 }
1063 else if (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE)
1064 {
1065 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
1066 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1067 }
1068 else if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
1069 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
1070 {
1071 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1072 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1073 }
1074 else
1075 {
1076 s->gc = s->face->gc;
1077 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
1078 }
1079
1080 /* GC must have been set. */
1081 eassert (s->gc != 0);
1082 }
1083
1084
1085 /* Set clipping for output of glyph string S. S may be part of a mode
1086 line or menu if we don't have X toolkit support. */
1087
1088 static inline void
1089 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (struct glyph_string *s)
1090 {
1091 XRectangle *r = s->clip;
1092 int n = get_glyph_string_clip_rects (s, r, 2);
1093
1094 if (n > 0)
1095 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, r, n, Unsorted);
1096 s->num_clips = n;
1097 }
1098
1099
1100 /* Set SRC's clipping for output of glyph string DST. This is called
1101 when we are drawing DST's left_overhang or right_overhang only in
1102 the area of SRC. */
1103
1104 static void
1105 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (struct glyph_string *src, struct glyph_string *dst)
1106 {
1107 XRectangle r;
1108
1109 r.x = src->x;
1110 r.width = src->width;
1111 r.y = src->y;
1112 r.height = src->height;
1113 dst->clip[0] = r;
1114 dst->num_clips = 1;
1115 XSetClipRectangles (dst->display, dst->gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
1116 }
1117
1118
1119 /* RIF:
1120 Compute left and right overhang of glyph string S. */
1121
1122 static void
1123 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs (struct glyph_string *s)
1124 {
1125 if (s->cmp == NULL
1126 && (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
1127 || s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH))
1128 {
1129 struct font_metrics metrics;
1130
1131 if (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
1132 {
1133 unsigned *code = alloca (sizeof (unsigned) * s->nchars);
1134 struct font *font = s->font;
1135 int i;
1136
1137 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; i++)
1138 code[i] = (s->char2b[i].byte1 << 8) | s->char2b[i].byte2;
1139 font->driver->text_extents (font, code, s->nchars, &metrics);
1140 }
1141 else
1142 {
1143 Lisp_Object gstring = composition_gstring_from_id (s->cmp_id);
1144
1145 composition_gstring_width (gstring, s->cmp_from, s->cmp_to, &metrics);
1146 }
1147 s->right_overhang = (metrics.rbearing > metrics.width
1148 ? metrics.rbearing - metrics.width : 0);
1149 s->left_overhang = metrics.lbearing < 0 ? - metrics.lbearing : 0;
1150 }
1151 else if (s->cmp)
1152 {
1153 s->right_overhang = s->cmp->rbearing - s->cmp->pixel_width;
1154 s->left_overhang = - s->cmp->lbearing;
1155 }
1156 }
1157
1158
1159 /* Fill rectangle X, Y, W, H with background color of glyph string S. */
1160
1161 static inline void
1162 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (struct glyph_string *s, int x, int y, int w, int h)
1163 {
1164 XGCValues xgcv;
1165 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
1166 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
1167 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
1168 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
1169 }
1170
1171
1172 /* Draw the background of glyph_string S. If S->background_filled_p
1173 is non-zero don't draw it. FORCE_P non-zero means draw the
1174 background even if it wouldn't be drawn normally. This is used
1175 when a string preceding S draws into the background of S, or S
1176 contains the first component of a composition. */
1177
1178 static void
1179 x_draw_glyph_string_background (struct glyph_string *s, int force_p)
1180 {
1181 /* Nothing to do if background has already been drawn or if it
1182 shouldn't be drawn in the first place. */
1183 if (!s->background_filled_p)
1184 {
1185 int box_line_width = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
1186
1187 if (s->stippled_p)
1188 {
1189 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
1190 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
1191 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x,
1192 s->y + box_line_width,
1193 s->background_width,
1194 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1195 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
1196 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1197 }
1198 else if (FONT_HEIGHT (s->font) < s->height - 2 * box_line_width
1199 || s->font_not_found_p
1200 || s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
1201 || force_p)
1202 {
1203 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, s->x, s->y + box_line_width,
1204 s->background_width,
1205 s->height - 2 * box_line_width);
1206 s->background_filled_p = 1;
1207 }
1208 }
1209 }
1210
1211
1212 /* Draw the foreground of glyph string S. */
1213
1214 static void
1215 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
1216 {
1217 int i, x;
1218
1219 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1220 of S to the right of that box line. */
1221 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1222 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1223 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1224 else
1225 x = s->x;
1226
1227 /* Draw characters of S as rectangles if S's font could not be
1228 loaded. */
1229 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1230 {
1231 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; ++i)
1232 {
1233 struct glyph *g = s->first_glyph + i;
1234 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window,
1235 s->gc, x, s->y, g->pixel_width - 1,
1236 s->height - 1);
1237 x += g->pixel_width;
1238 }
1239 }
1240 else
1241 {
1242 struct font *font = s->font;
1243 int boff = font->baseline_offset;
1244 int y;
1245
1246 if (font->vertical_centering)
1247 boff = VCENTER_BASELINE_OFFSET (font, s->f) - boff;
1248
1249 y = s->ybase - boff;
1250 if (s->for_overlaps
1251 || (s->background_filled_p && s->hl != DRAW_CURSOR))
1252 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x, y, 0);
1253 else
1254 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x, y, 1);
1255 if (s->face->overstrike)
1256 font->driver->draw (s, 0, s->nchars, x + 1, y, 0);
1257 }
1258 }
1259
1260 /* Draw the foreground of composite glyph string S. */
1261
1262 static void
1263 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
1264 {
1265 int i, j, x;
1266 struct font *font = s->font;
1267
1268 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1269 of S to the right of that box line. */
1270 if (s->face && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1271 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1272 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1273 else
1274 x = s->x;
1275
1276 /* S is a glyph string for a composition. S->cmp_from is the index
1277 of the first character drawn for glyphs of this composition.
1278 S->cmp_from == 0 means we are drawing the very first character of
1279 this composition. */
1280
1281 /* Draw a rectangle for the composition if the font for the very
1282 first character of the composition could not be loaded. */
1283 if (s->font_not_found_p)
1284 {
1285 if (s->cmp_from == 0)
1286 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, s->y,
1287 s->width - 1, s->height - 1);
1288 }
1289 else if (! s->first_glyph->u.cmp.automatic)
1290 {
1291 int y = s->ybase;
1292
1293 for (i = 0, j = s->cmp_from; i < s->nchars; i++, j++)
1294 /* TAB in a composition means display glyphs with padding
1295 space on the left or right. */
1296 if (COMPOSITION_GLYPH (s->cmp, j) != '\t')
1297 {
1298 int xx = x + s->cmp->offsets[j * 2];
1299 int yy = y - s->cmp->offsets[j * 2 + 1];
1300
1301 font->driver->draw (s, j, j + 1, xx, yy, 0);
1302 if (s->face->overstrike)
1303 font->driver->draw (s, j, j + 1, xx + 1, yy, 0);
1304 }
1305 }
1306 else
1307 {
1308 Lisp_Object gstring = composition_gstring_from_id (s->cmp_id);
1309 Lisp_Object glyph;
1310 int y = s->ybase;
1311 int width = 0;
1312
1313 for (i = j = s->cmp_from; i < s->cmp_to; i++)
1314 {
1315 glyph = LGSTRING_GLYPH (gstring, i);
1316 if (NILP (LGLYPH_ADJUSTMENT (glyph)))
1317 width += LGLYPH_WIDTH (glyph);
1318 else
1319 {
1320 int xoff, yoff, wadjust;
1321
1322 if (j < i)
1323 {
1324 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x, y, 0);
1325 if (s->face->overstrike)
1326 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x + 1, y, 0);
1327 x += width;
1328 }
1329 xoff = LGLYPH_XOFF (glyph);
1330 yoff = LGLYPH_YOFF (glyph);
1331 wadjust = LGLYPH_WADJUST (glyph);
1332 font->driver->draw (s, i, i + 1, x + xoff, y + yoff, 0);
1333 if (s->face->overstrike)
1334 font->driver->draw (s, i, i + 1, x + xoff + 1, y + yoff, 0);
1335 x += wadjust;
1336 j = i + 1;
1337 width = 0;
1338 }
1339 }
1340 if (j < i)
1341 {
1342 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x, y, 0);
1343 if (s->face->overstrike)
1344 font->driver->draw (s, j, i, x + 1, y, 0);
1345 }
1346 }
1347 }
1348
1349
1350 /* Draw the foreground of glyph string S for glyphless characters. */
1351
1352 static void
1353 x_draw_glyphless_glyph_string_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
1354 {
1355 struct glyph *glyph = s->first_glyph;
1356 XChar2b char2b[8];
1357 int x, i, j;
1358
1359 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing the text
1360 of S to the right of that box line. */
1361 if (s->face && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
1362 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p)
1363 x = s->x + eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
1364 else
1365 x = s->x;
1366
1367 s->char2b = char2b;
1368
1369 for (i = 0; i < s->nchars; i++, glyph++)
1370 {
1371 char buf[7], *str = NULL;
1372 int len = glyph->u.glyphless.len;
1373
1374 if (glyph->u.glyphless.method == GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_ACRONYM)
1375 {
1376 if (len > 0
1377 && CHAR_TABLE_P (Vglyphless_char_display)
1378 && (CHAR_TABLE_EXTRA_SLOTS (XCHAR_TABLE (Vglyphless_char_display))
1379 >= 1))
1380 {
1381 Lisp_Object acronym
1382 = (! glyph->u.glyphless.for_no_font
1383 ? CHAR_TABLE_REF (Vglyphless_char_display,
1384 glyph->u.glyphless.ch)
1385 : XCHAR_TABLE (Vglyphless_char_display)->extras[0]);
1386 if (STRINGP (acronym))
1387 str = SSDATA (acronym);
1388 }
1389 }
1390 else if (glyph->u.glyphless.method == GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_HEX_CODE)
1391 {
1392 sprintf ((char *) buf, "%0*X",
1393 glyph->u.glyphless.ch < 0x10000 ? 4 : 6,
1394 glyph->u.glyphless.ch);
1395 str = buf;
1396 }
1397
1398 if (str)
1399 {
1400 int upper_len = (len + 1) / 2;
1401 unsigned code;
1402
1403 /* It is assured that all LEN characters in STR is ASCII. */
1404 for (j = 0; j < len; j++)
1405 {
1406 code = s->font->driver->encode_char (s->font, str[j]);
1407 STORE_XCHAR2B (char2b + j, code >> 8, code & 0xFF);
1408 }
1409 s->font->driver->draw (s, 0, upper_len,
1410 x + glyph->slice.glyphless.upper_xoff,
1411 s->ybase + glyph->slice.glyphless.upper_yoff,
1412 0);
1413 s->font->driver->draw (s, upper_len, len,
1414 x + glyph->slice.glyphless.lower_xoff,
1415 s->ybase + glyph->slice.glyphless.lower_yoff,
1416 0);
1417 }
1418 if (glyph->u.glyphless.method != GLYPHLESS_DISPLAY_THIN_SPACE)
1419 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
1420 x, s->ybase - glyph->ascent,
1421 glyph->pixel_width - 1,
1422 glyph->ascent + glyph->descent - 1);
1423 x += glyph->pixel_width;
1424 }
1425 }
1426
1427 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
1428
1429 static Boolean cvt_string_to_pixel (Display *, XrmValue *, Cardinal *,
1430 XrmValue *, XrmValue *, XtPointer *);
1431 static void cvt_pixel_dtor (XtAppContext, XrmValue *, XtPointer,
1432 XrmValue *, Cardinal *);
1433
1434 #ifdef USE_LUCID
1435
1436 /* Return the frame on which widget WIDGET is used.. Abort if frame
1437 cannot be determined. */
1438
1439 static struct frame *
1440 x_frame_of_widget (Widget widget)
1441 {
1442 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
1443 Lisp_Object tail;
1444 struct frame *f;
1445
1446 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (XtDisplay (widget));
1447
1448 /* Find the top-level shell of the widget. Note that this function
1449 can be called when the widget is not yet realized, so XtWindow
1450 (widget) == 0. That's the reason we can't simply use
1451 x_any_window_to_frame. */
1452 while (!XtIsTopLevelShell (widget))
1453 widget = XtParent (widget);
1454
1455 /* Look for a frame with that top-level widget. Allocate the color
1456 on that frame to get the right gamma correction value. */
1457 for (tail = Vframe_list; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
1458 if (FRAMEP (XCAR (tail))
1459 && (f = XFRAME (XCAR (tail)),
1460 (FRAME_X_P (f)
1461 && f->output_data.nothing != 1
1462 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo))
1463 && f->output_data.x->widget == widget)
1464 return f;
1465
1466 emacs_abort ();
1467 }
1468
1469 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1470 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1471 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1472 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1473 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1474 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1475
1476 int
1477 x_alloc_lighter_color_for_widget (Widget widget, Display *display, Colormap cmap,
1478 unsigned long *pixel, double factor, int delta)
1479 {
1480 struct frame *f = x_frame_of_widget (widget);
1481 return x_alloc_lighter_color (f, display, cmap, pixel, factor, delta);
1482 }
1483
1484 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
1485
1486
1487 /* Structure specifying which arguments should be passed by Xt to
1488 cvt_string_to_pixel. We want the widget's screen and colormap. */
1489
1490 static XtConvertArgRec cvt_string_to_pixel_args[] =
1491 {
1492 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.screen),
1493 sizeof (Screen *)},
1494 {XtWidgetBaseOffset, (XtPointer) XtOffset (Widget, core.colormap),
1495 sizeof (Colormap)}
1496 };
1497
1498
1499 /* The address of this variable is returned by
1500 cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1501
1502 static Pixel cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1503
1504
1505 /* Convert a color name to a pixel color.
1506
1507 DPY is the display we are working on.
1508
1509 ARGS is an array of *NARGS XrmValue structures holding additional
1510 information about the widget for which the conversion takes place.
1511 The contents of this array are determined by the specification
1512 in cvt_string_to_pixel_args.
1513
1514 FROM is a pointer to an XrmValue which points to the color name to
1515 convert. TO is an XrmValue in which to return the pixel color.
1516
1517 CLOSURE_RET is a pointer to user-data, in which we record if
1518 we allocated the color or not.
1519
1520 Value is True if successful, False otherwise. */
1521
1522 static Boolean
1523 cvt_string_to_pixel (Display *dpy, XrmValue *args, Cardinal *nargs,
1524 XrmValue *from, XrmValue *to,
1525 XtPointer *closure_ret)
1526 {
1527 Screen *screen;
1528 Colormap cmap;
1529 Pixel pixel;
1530 String color_name;
1531 XColor color;
1532
1533 if (*nargs != 2)
1534 {
1535 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1536 "wrongParameters", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1537 "XtToolkitError",
1538 "Screen and colormap args required", NULL, NULL);
1539 return False;
1540 }
1541
1542 screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1543 cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1544 color_name = (String) from->addr;
1545
1546 if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultBackground) == 0)
1547 {
1548 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1549 pixel = WhitePixelOfScreen (screen);
1550 }
1551 else if (strcmp (color_name, XtDefaultForeground) == 0)
1552 {
1553 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) False;
1554 pixel = BlackPixelOfScreen (screen);
1555 }
1556 else if (XParseColor (dpy, cmap, color_name, &color)
1557 && x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (dpy, cmap, &color))
1558 {
1559 pixel = color.pixel;
1560 *closure_ret = (XtPointer) True;
1561 }
1562 else
1563 {
1564 String params[1];
1565 Cardinal nparams = 1;
1566
1567 params[0] = color_name;
1568 XtAppWarningMsg (XtDisplayToApplicationContext (dpy),
1569 "badValue", "cvt_string_to_pixel",
1570 "XtToolkitError", "Invalid color `%s'",
1571 params, &nparams);
1572 return False;
1573 }
1574
1575 if (to->addr != NULL)
1576 {
1577 if (to->size < sizeof (Pixel))
1578 {
1579 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1580 return False;
1581 }
1582
1583 *(Pixel *) to->addr = pixel;
1584 }
1585 else
1586 {
1587 cvt_string_to_pixel_value = pixel;
1588 to->addr = (XtPointer) &cvt_string_to_pixel_value;
1589 }
1590
1591 to->size = sizeof (Pixel);
1592 return True;
1593 }
1594
1595
1596 /* Free a pixel color which was previously allocated via
1597 cvt_string_to_pixel. This is registered as the destructor
1598 for this type of resource via XtSetTypeConverter.
1599
1600 APP is the application context in which we work.
1601
1602 TO is a pointer to an XrmValue holding the color to free.
1603 CLOSURE is the value we stored in CLOSURE_RET for this color
1604 in cvt_string_to_pixel.
1605
1606 ARGS and NARGS are like for cvt_string_to_pixel. */
1607
1608 static void
1609 cvt_pixel_dtor (XtAppContext app, XrmValuePtr to, XtPointer closure, XrmValuePtr args,
1610 Cardinal *nargs)
1611 {
1612 if (*nargs != 2)
1613 {
1614 XtAppWarningMsg (app, "wrongParameters", "cvt_pixel_dtor",
1615 "XtToolkitError",
1616 "Screen and colormap arguments required",
1617 NULL, NULL);
1618 }
1619 else if (closure != NULL)
1620 {
1621 /* We did allocate the pixel, so free it. */
1622 Screen *screen = *(Screen **) args[0].addr;
1623 Colormap cmap = *(Colormap *) args[1].addr;
1624 x_free_dpy_colors (DisplayOfScreen (screen), screen, cmap,
1625 (Pixel *) to->addr, 1);
1626 }
1627 }
1628
1629
1630 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
1631
1632
1633 /* Value is an array of XColor structures for the contents of the
1634 color map of display DPY. Set *NCELLS to the size of the array.
1635 Note that this probably shouldn't be called for large color maps,
1636 say a 24-bit TrueColor map. */
1637
1638 static const XColor *
1639 x_color_cells (Display *dpy, int *ncells)
1640 {
1641 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1642
1643 if (dpyinfo->color_cells == NULL)
1644 {
1645 Screen *screen = dpyinfo->screen;
1646 int ncolor_cells = XDisplayCells (dpy, XScreenNumberOfScreen (screen));
1647 int i;
1648
1649 dpyinfo->color_cells = xnmalloc (ncolor_cells,
1650 sizeof *dpyinfo->color_cells);
1651 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells = ncolor_cells;
1652
1653 for (i = 0; i < ncolor_cells; ++i)
1654 dpyinfo->color_cells[i].pixel = i;
1655
1656 XQueryColors (dpy, dpyinfo->cmap,
1657 dpyinfo->color_cells, ncolor_cells);
1658 }
1659
1660 *ncells = dpyinfo->ncolor_cells;
1661 return dpyinfo->color_cells;
1662 }
1663
1664
1665 /* On frame F, translate pixel colors to RGB values for the NCOLORS
1666 colors in COLORS. Use cached information, if available. */
1667
1668 void
1669 x_query_colors (struct frame *f, XColor *colors, int ncolors)
1670 {
1671 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1672
1673 if (dpyinfo->color_cells)
1674 {
1675 int i;
1676 for (i = 0; i < ncolors; ++i)
1677 {
1678 unsigned long pixel = colors[i].pixel;
1679 eassert (pixel < dpyinfo->ncolor_cells);
1680 eassert (dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel].pixel == pixel);
1681 colors[i] = dpyinfo->color_cells[pixel];
1682 }
1683 }
1684 else
1685 XQueryColors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), colors, ncolors);
1686 }
1687
1688
1689 /* On frame F, translate pixel color to RGB values for the color in
1690 COLOR. Use cached information, if available. */
1691
1692 void
1693 x_query_color (struct frame *f, XColor *color)
1694 {
1695 x_query_colors (f, color, 1);
1696 }
1697
1698
1699 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on DISPLAY, colormap CMAP. If an
1700 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1701 Value is non-zero if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1702 allocated. */
1703
1704 static int
1705 x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (Display *dpy, Colormap cmap, XColor *color)
1706 {
1707 int rc;
1708
1709 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color);
1710 if (rc == 0)
1711 {
1712 /* If we got to this point, the colormap is full, so we're going
1713 to try to get the next closest color. The algorithm used is
1714 a least-squares matching, which is what X uses for closest
1715 color matching with StaticColor visuals. */
1716 int nearest, i;
1717 int max_color_delta = 255;
1718 int max_delta = 3 * max_color_delta;
1719 int nearest_delta = max_delta + 1;
1720 int ncells;
1721 const XColor *cells = x_color_cells (dpy, &ncells);
1722
1723 for (nearest = i = 0; i < ncells; ++i)
1724 {
1725 int dred = (color->red >> 8) - (cells[i].red >> 8);
1726 int dgreen = (color->green >> 8) - (cells[i].green >> 8);
1727 int dblue = (color->blue >> 8) - (cells[i].blue >> 8);
1728 int delta = dred * dred + dgreen * dgreen + dblue * dblue;
1729
1730 if (delta < nearest_delta)
1731 {
1732 nearest = i;
1733 nearest_delta = delta;
1734 }
1735 }
1736
1737 color->red = cells[nearest].red;
1738 color->green = cells[nearest].green;
1739 color->blue = cells[nearest].blue;
1740 rc = XAllocColor (dpy, cmap, color);
1741 }
1742 else
1743 {
1744 /* If allocation succeeded, and the allocated pixel color is not
1745 equal to a cached pixel color recorded earlier, there was a
1746 change in the colormap, so clear the color cache. */
1747 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
1748 XColor *cached_color;
1749
1750 if (dpyinfo->color_cells
1751 && (cached_color = &dpyinfo->color_cells[color->pixel],
1752 (cached_color->red != color->red
1753 || cached_color->blue != color->blue
1754 || cached_color->green != color->green)))
1755 {
1756 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
1757 dpyinfo->color_cells = NULL;
1758 dpyinfo->ncolor_cells = 0;
1759 }
1760 }
1761
1762 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1763 if (rc)
1764 register_color (color->pixel);
1765 #endif /* DEBUG_X_COLORS */
1766
1767 return rc;
1768 }
1769
1770
1771 /* Allocate the color COLOR->pixel on frame F, colormap CMAP. If an
1772 exact match can't be allocated, try the nearest color available.
1773 Value is non-zero if successful. Set *COLOR to the color
1774 allocated. */
1775
1776 int
1777 x_alloc_nearest_color (struct frame *f, Colormap cmap, XColor *color)
1778 {
1779 gamma_correct (f, color);
1780 return x_alloc_nearest_color_1 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), cmap, color);
1781 }
1782
1783
1784 /* Allocate color PIXEL on frame F. PIXEL must already be allocated.
1785 It's necessary to do this instead of just using PIXEL directly to
1786 get color reference counts right. */
1787
1788 unsigned long
1789 x_copy_color (struct frame *f, long unsigned int pixel)
1790 {
1791 XColor color;
1792
1793 color.pixel = pixel;
1794 BLOCK_INPUT;
1795 x_query_color (f, &color);
1796 XAllocColor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f), &color);
1797 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
1798 #ifdef DEBUG_X_COLORS
1799 register_color (pixel);
1800 #endif
1801 return color.pixel;
1802 }
1803
1804
1805 /* Brightness beyond which a color won't have its highlight brightness
1806 boosted.
1807
1808 Nominally, highlight colors for `3d' faces are calculated by
1809 brightening an object's color by a constant scale factor, but this
1810 doesn't yield good results for dark colors, so for colors who's
1811 brightness is less than this value (on a scale of 0-65535) have an
1812 use an additional additive factor.
1813
1814 The value here is set so that the default menu-bar/mode-line color
1815 (grey75) will not have its highlights changed at all. */
1816 #define HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT 48000
1817
1818
1819 /* Allocate a color which is lighter or darker than *PIXEL by FACTOR
1820 or DELTA. Try a color with RGB values multiplied by FACTOR first.
1821 If this produces the same color as PIXEL, try a color where all RGB
1822 values have DELTA added. Return the allocated color in *PIXEL.
1823 DISPLAY is the X display, CMAP is the colormap to operate on.
1824 Value is non-zero if successful. */
1825
1826 static int
1827 x_alloc_lighter_color (struct frame *f, Display *display, Colormap cmap, long unsigned int *pixel, double factor, int delta)
1828 {
1829 XColor color, new;
1830 long bright;
1831 int success_p;
1832
1833 /* Get RGB color values. */
1834 color.pixel = *pixel;
1835 x_query_color (f, &color);
1836
1837 /* Change RGB values by specified FACTOR. Avoid overflow! */
1838 eassert (factor >= 0);
1839 new.red = min (0xffff, factor * color.red);
1840 new.green = min (0xffff, factor * color.green);
1841 new.blue = min (0xffff, factor * color.blue);
1842
1843 /* Calculate brightness of COLOR. */
1844 bright = (2 * color.red + 3 * color.green + color.blue) / 6;
1845
1846 /* We only boost colors that are darker than
1847 HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT. */
1848 if (bright < HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT)
1849 /* Make an additive adjustment to NEW, because it's dark enough so
1850 that scaling by FACTOR alone isn't enough. */
1851 {
1852 /* How far below the limit this color is (0 - 1, 1 being darker). */
1853 double dimness = 1 - (double)bright / HIGHLIGHT_COLOR_DARK_BOOST_LIMIT;
1854 /* The additive adjustment. */
1855 int min_delta = delta * dimness * factor / 2;
1856
1857 if (factor < 1)
1858 {
1859 new.red = max (0, new.red - min_delta);
1860 new.green = max (0, new.green - min_delta);
1861 new.blue = max (0, new.blue - min_delta);
1862 }
1863 else
1864 {
1865 new.red = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.red);
1866 new.green = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.green);
1867 new.blue = min (0xffff, min_delta + new.blue);
1868 }
1869 }
1870
1871 /* Try to allocate the color. */
1872 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1873 if (success_p)
1874 {
1875 if (new.pixel == *pixel)
1876 {
1877 /* If we end up with the same color as before, try adding
1878 delta to the RGB values. */
1879 x_free_colors (f, &new.pixel, 1);
1880
1881 new.red = min (0xffff, delta + color.red);
1882 new.green = min (0xffff, delta + color.green);
1883 new.blue = min (0xffff, delta + color.blue);
1884 success_p = x_alloc_nearest_color (f, cmap, &new);
1885 }
1886 else
1887 success_p = 1;
1888 *pixel = new.pixel;
1889 }
1890
1891 return success_p;
1892 }
1893
1894
1895 /* Set up the foreground color for drawing relief lines of glyph
1896 string S. RELIEF is a pointer to a struct relief containing the GC
1897 with which lines will be drawn. Use a color that is FACTOR or
1898 DELTA lighter or darker than the relief's background which is found
1899 in S->f->output_data.x->relief_background. If such a color cannot
1900 be allocated, use DEFAULT_PIXEL, instead. */
1901
1902 static void
1903 x_setup_relief_color (struct frame *f, struct relief *relief, double factor, int delta, long unsigned int default_pixel)
1904 {
1905 XGCValues xgcv;
1906 struct x_output *di = f->output_data.x;
1907 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCLineWidth | GCGraphicsExposures;
1908 unsigned long pixel;
1909 unsigned long background = di->relief_background;
1910 Colormap cmap = FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f);
1911 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
1912 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
1913
1914 xgcv.graphics_exposures = False;
1915 xgcv.line_width = 1;
1916
1917 /* Free previously allocated color. The color cell will be reused
1918 when it has been freed as many times as it was allocated, so this
1919 doesn't affect faces using the same colors. */
1920 if (relief->gc
1921 && relief->allocated_p)
1922 {
1923 x_free_colors (f, &relief->pixel, 1);
1924 relief->allocated_p = 0;
1925 }
1926
1927 /* Allocate new color. */
1928 xgcv.foreground = default_pixel;
1929 pixel = background;
1930 if (dpyinfo->n_planes != 1
1931 && x_alloc_lighter_color (f, dpy, cmap, &pixel, factor, delta))
1932 {
1933 relief->allocated_p = 1;
1934 xgcv.foreground = relief->pixel = pixel;
1935 }
1936
1937 if (relief->gc == 0)
1938 {
1939 xgcv.stipple = dpyinfo->gray;
1940 mask |= GCStipple;
1941 relief->gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), mask, &xgcv);
1942 }
1943 else
1944 XChangeGC (dpy, relief->gc, mask, &xgcv);
1945 }
1946
1947
1948 /* Set up colors for the relief lines around glyph string S. */
1949
1950 static void
1951 x_setup_relief_colors (struct glyph_string *s)
1952 {
1953 struct x_output *di = s->f->output_data.x;
1954 unsigned long color;
1955
1956 if (s->face->use_box_color_for_shadows_p)
1957 color = s->face->box_color;
1958 else if (s->first_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH
1959 && s->img->pixmap
1960 && !IMAGE_BACKGROUND_TRANSPARENT (s->img, s->f, 0))
1961 color = IMAGE_BACKGROUND (s->img, s->f, 0);
1962 else
1963 {
1964 XGCValues xgcv;
1965
1966 /* Get the background color of the face. */
1967 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCBackground, &xgcv);
1968 color = xgcv.background;
1969 }
1970
1971 if (di->white_relief.gc == 0
1972 || color != di->relief_background)
1973 {
1974 di->relief_background = color;
1975 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->white_relief, 1.2, 0x8000,
1976 WHITE_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
1977 x_setup_relief_color (s->f, &di->black_relief, 0.6, 0x4000,
1978 BLACK_PIX_DEFAULT (s->f));
1979 }
1980 }
1981
1982
1983 /* Draw a relief on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X,
1984 TOP_Y, RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the relief
1985 to draw, it must be >= 0. RAISED_P non-zero means draw a raised
1986 relief. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the left side of
1987 the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a relief on the right
1988 side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping rectangle to use
1989 when drawing. */
1990
1991 static void
1992 x_draw_relief_rect (struct frame *f,
1993 int left_x, int top_y, int right_x, int bottom_y, int width,
1994 int raised_p, int top_p, int bot_p, int left_p, int right_p,
1995 XRectangle *clip_rect)
1996 {
1997 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
1998 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
1999 int i;
2000 GC gc;
2001
2002 if (raised_p)
2003 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
2004 else
2005 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
2006 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2007
2008 /* This code is more complicated than it has to be, because of two
2009 minor hacks to make the boxes look nicer: (i) if width > 1, draw
2010 the outermost line using the black relief. (ii) Omit the four
2011 corner pixels. */
2012
2013 /* Top. */
2014 if (top_p)
2015 {
2016 if (width == 1)
2017 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2018 left_x + (left_p ? 1 : 0), top_y,
2019 right_x + (right_p ? 0 : 1), top_y);
2020
2021 for (i = 1; i < width; ++i)
2022 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2023 left_x + i * left_p, top_y + i,
2024 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, top_y + i);
2025 }
2026
2027 /* Left. */
2028 if (left_p)
2029 {
2030 if (width == 1)
2031 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc, left_x, top_y + 1, left_x, bottom_y);
2032
2033 XClearArea (dpy, window, left_x, top_y, 1, 1, False);
2034 XClearArea (dpy, window, left_x, bottom_y, 1, 1, False);
2035
2036 for (i = (width > 1 ? 1 : 0); i < width; ++i)
2037 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2038 left_x + i, top_y + i, left_x + i, bottom_y - i + 1);
2039 }
2040
2041 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2042 if (raised_p)
2043 gc = f->output_data.x->black_relief.gc;
2044 else
2045 gc = f->output_data.x->white_relief.gc;
2046 XSetClipRectangles (dpy, gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2047
2048 if (width > 1)
2049 {
2050 /* Outermost top line. */
2051 if (top_p)
2052 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2053 left_x + (left_p ? 1 : 0), top_y,
2054 right_x + (right_p ? 0 : 1), top_y);
2055
2056 /* Outermost left line. */
2057 if (left_p)
2058 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc, left_x, top_y + 1, left_x, bottom_y);
2059 }
2060
2061 /* Bottom. */
2062 if (bot_p)
2063 {
2064 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2065 left_x + (left_p ? 1 : 0), bottom_y,
2066 right_x + (right_p ? 0 : 1), bottom_y);
2067 for (i = 1; i < width; ++i)
2068 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2069 left_x + i * left_p, bottom_y - i,
2070 right_x + 1 - i * right_p, bottom_y - i);
2071 }
2072
2073 /* Right. */
2074 if (right_p)
2075 {
2076 XClearArea (dpy, window, right_x, top_y, 1, 1, False);
2077 XClearArea (dpy, window, right_x, bottom_y, 1, 1, False);
2078 for (i = 0; i < width; ++i)
2079 XDrawLine (dpy, window, gc,
2080 right_x - i, top_y + i + 1, right_x - i, bottom_y - i);
2081 }
2082
2083 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
2084 }
2085
2086
2087 /* Draw a box on frame F inside the rectangle given by LEFT_X, TOP_Y,
2088 RIGHT_X, and BOTTOM_Y. WIDTH is the thickness of the lines to
2089 draw, it must be >= 0. LEFT_P non-zero means draw a line on the
2090 left side of the rectangle. RIGHT_P non-zero means draw a line
2091 on the right side of the rectangle. CLIP_RECT is the clipping
2092 rectangle to use when drawing. */
2093
2094 static void
2095 x_draw_box_rect (struct glyph_string *s,
2096 int left_x, int top_y, int right_x, int bottom_y, int width,
2097 int left_p, int right_p, XRectangle *clip_rect)
2098 {
2099 XGCValues xgcv;
2100
2101 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2102 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->box_color);
2103 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
2104
2105 /* Top. */
2106 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2107 left_x, top_y, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2108
2109 /* Left. */
2110 if (left_p)
2111 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2112 left_x, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2113
2114 /* Bottom. */
2115 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2116 left_x, bottom_y - width + 1, right_x - left_x + 1, width);
2117
2118 /* Right. */
2119 if (right_p)
2120 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2121 right_x - width + 1, top_y, width, bottom_y - top_y + 1);
2122
2123 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2124 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2125 }
2126
2127
2128 /* Draw a box around glyph string S. */
2129
2130 static void
2131 x_draw_glyph_string_box (struct glyph_string *s)
2132 {
2133 int width, left_x, right_x, top_y, bottom_y, last_x, raised_p;
2134 int left_p, right_p;
2135 struct glyph *last_glyph;
2136 XRectangle clip_rect;
2137
2138 last_x = ((s->row->full_width_p && !s->w->pseudo_window_p)
2139 ? WINDOW_RIGHT_EDGE_X (s->w)
2140 : window_box_right (s->w, s->area));
2141
2142 /* The glyph that may have a right box line. */
2143 last_glyph = (s->cmp || s->img
2144 ? s->first_glyph
2145 : s->first_glyph + s->nchars - 1);
2146
2147 width = eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2148 raised_p = s->face->box == FACE_RAISED_BOX;
2149 left_x = s->x;
2150 right_x = (s->row->full_width_p && s->extends_to_end_of_line_p
2151 ? last_x - 1
2152 : min (last_x, s->x + s->background_width) - 1);
2153 top_y = s->y;
2154 bottom_y = top_y + s->height - 1;
2155
2156 left_p = (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2157 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2158 && (s->prev == NULL
2159 || s->prev->hl != s->hl)));
2160 right_p = (last_glyph->right_box_line_p
2161 || (s->hl == DRAW_MOUSE_FACE
2162 && (s->next == NULL
2163 || s->next->hl != s->hl)));
2164
2165 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2166
2167 if (s->face->box == FACE_SIMPLE_BOX)
2168 x_draw_box_rect (s, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y, width,
2169 left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2170 else
2171 {
2172 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2173 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, left_x, top_y, right_x, bottom_y,
2174 width, raised_p, 1, 1, left_p, right_p, &clip_rect);
2175 }
2176 }
2177
2178
2179 /* Draw foreground of image glyph string S. */
2180
2181 static void
2182 x_draw_image_foreground (struct glyph_string *s)
2183 {
2184 int x = s->x;
2185 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2186
2187 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2188 right of that line. */
2189 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2190 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2191 && s->slice.x == 0)
2192 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2193
2194 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2195 by that margin. */
2196 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2197 x += s->img->hmargin;
2198 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2199 y += s->img->vmargin;
2200
2201 if (s->img->pixmap)
2202 {
2203 if (s->img->mask)
2204 {
2205 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2206 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2207 trust on the shape extension to be available
2208 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2209 manually. */
2210 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2211 | GCFunction);
2212 XGCValues xgcv;
2213 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2214
2215 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2216 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x;
2217 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y;
2218 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2219 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2220
2221 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2222 image_rect.x = x;
2223 image_rect.y = y;
2224 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2225 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2226 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2227 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2228 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2229 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2230 }
2231 else
2232 {
2233 XRectangle clip_rect, image_rect, r;
2234
2235 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &clip_rect);
2236 image_rect.x = x;
2237 image_rect.y = y;
2238 image_rect.width = s->slice.width;
2239 image_rect.height = s->slice.height;
2240 if (x_intersect_rectangles (&clip_rect, &image_rect, &r))
2241 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2242 s->slice.x + r.x - x, s->slice.y + r.y - y,
2243 r.width, r.height, r.x, r.y);
2244
2245 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2246 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2247 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2248 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2249 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2250 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2251 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2252 {
2253 int relief = s->img->relief;
2254 if (relief < 0) relief = -relief;
2255 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2256 x - relief, y - relief,
2257 s->slice.width + relief*2 - 1,
2258 s->slice.height + relief*2 - 1);
2259 }
2260 }
2261 }
2262 else
2263 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2264 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y,
2265 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
2266 }
2267
2268
2269 /* Draw a relief around the image glyph string S. */
2270
2271 static void
2272 x_draw_image_relief (struct glyph_string *s)
2273 {
2274 int x0, y0, x1, y1, thick, raised_p;
2275 int extra_x, extra_y;
2276 XRectangle r;
2277 int x = s->x;
2278 int y = s->ybase - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2279
2280 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2281 right of that line. */
2282 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2283 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2284 && s->slice.x == 0)
2285 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2286
2287 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2288 by that margin. */
2289 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2290 x += s->img->hmargin;
2291 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2292 y += s->img->vmargin;
2293
2294 if (s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN
2295 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED)
2296 {
2297 thick = tool_bar_button_relief >= 0 ? tool_bar_button_relief : DEFAULT_TOOL_BAR_BUTTON_RELIEF;
2298 raised_p = s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED;
2299 }
2300 else
2301 {
2302 thick = eabs (s->img->relief);
2303 raised_p = s->img->relief > 0;
2304 }
2305
2306 extra_x = extra_y = 0;
2307 if (s->face->id == TOOL_BAR_FACE_ID)
2308 {
2309 if (CONSP (Vtool_bar_button_margin)
2310 && INTEGERP (XCAR (Vtool_bar_button_margin))
2311 && INTEGERP (XCDR (Vtool_bar_button_margin)))
2312 {
2313 extra_x = XINT (XCAR (Vtool_bar_button_margin));
2314 extra_y = XINT (XCDR (Vtool_bar_button_margin));
2315 }
2316 else if (INTEGERP (Vtool_bar_button_margin))
2317 extra_x = extra_y = XINT (Vtool_bar_button_margin);
2318 }
2319
2320 x0 = x - thick - extra_x;
2321 y0 = y - thick - extra_y;
2322 x1 = x + s->slice.width + thick - 1 + extra_x;
2323 y1 = y + s->slice.height + thick - 1 + extra_y;
2324
2325 x_setup_relief_colors (s);
2326 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2327 x_draw_relief_rect (s->f, x0, y0, x1, y1, thick, raised_p,
2328 s->slice.y == 0,
2329 s->slice.y + s->slice.height == s->img->height,
2330 s->slice.x == 0,
2331 s->slice.x + s->slice.width == s->img->width,
2332 &r);
2333 }
2334
2335
2336 /* Draw the foreground of image glyph string S to PIXMAP. */
2337
2338 static void
2339 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (struct glyph_string *s, Pixmap pixmap)
2340 {
2341 int x = 0;
2342 int y = s->ybase - s->y - image_ascent (s->img, s->face, &s->slice);
2343
2344 /* If first glyph of S has a left box line, start drawing it to the
2345 right of that line. */
2346 if (s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2347 && s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2348 && s->slice.x == 0)
2349 x += eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2350
2351 /* If there is a margin around the image, adjust x- and y-position
2352 by that margin. */
2353 if (s->slice.x == 0)
2354 x += s->img->hmargin;
2355 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2356 y += s->img->vmargin;
2357
2358 if (s->img->pixmap)
2359 {
2360 if (s->img->mask)
2361 {
2362 /* We can't set both a clip mask and use XSetClipRectangles
2363 because the latter also sets a clip mask. We also can't
2364 trust on the shape extension to be available
2365 (XShapeCombineRegion). So, compute the rectangle to draw
2366 manually. */
2367 unsigned long mask = (GCClipMask | GCClipXOrigin | GCClipYOrigin
2368 | GCFunction);
2369 XGCValues xgcv;
2370
2371 xgcv.clip_mask = s->img->mask;
2372 xgcv.clip_x_origin = x - s->slice.x;
2373 xgcv.clip_y_origin = y - s->slice.y;
2374 xgcv.function = GXcopy;
2375 XChangeGC (s->display, s->gc, mask, &xgcv);
2376
2377 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2378 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
2379 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
2380 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2381 }
2382 else
2383 {
2384 XCopyArea (s->display, s->img->pixmap, pixmap, s->gc,
2385 s->slice.x, s->slice.y,
2386 s->slice.width, s->slice.height, x, y);
2387
2388 /* When the image has a mask, we can expect that at
2389 least part of a mouse highlight or a block cursor will
2390 be visible. If the image doesn't have a mask, make
2391 a block cursor visible by drawing a rectangle around
2392 the image. I believe it's looking better if we do
2393 nothing here for mouse-face. */
2394 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR)
2395 {
2396 int r = s->img->relief;
2397 if (r < 0) r = -r;
2398 XDrawRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x - r, y - r,
2399 s->slice.width + r*2 - 1,
2400 s->slice.height + r*2 - 1);
2401 }
2402 }
2403 }
2404 else
2405 /* Draw a rectangle if image could not be loaded. */
2406 XDrawRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc, x, y,
2407 s->slice.width - 1, s->slice.height - 1);
2408 }
2409
2410
2411 /* Draw part of the background of glyph string S. X, Y, W, and H
2412 give the rectangle to draw. */
2413
2414 static void
2415 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (struct glyph_string *s, int x, int y, int w, int h)
2416 {
2417 if (s->stippled_p)
2418 {
2419 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2420 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2421 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x, y, w, h);
2422 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2423 }
2424 else
2425 x_clear_glyph_string_rect (s, x, y, w, h);
2426 }
2427
2428
2429 /* Draw image glyph string S.
2430
2431 s->y
2432 s->x +-------------------------
2433 | s->face->box
2434 |
2435 | +-------------------------
2436 | | s->img->margin
2437 | |
2438 | | +-------------------
2439 | | | the image
2440
2441 */
2442
2443 static void
2444 x_draw_image_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
2445 {
2446 int box_line_hwidth = eabs (s->face->box_line_width);
2447 int box_line_vwidth = max (s->face->box_line_width, 0);
2448 int height;
2449 Pixmap pixmap = None;
2450
2451 height = s->height;
2452 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2453 height -= box_line_vwidth;
2454 if (s->slice.y + s->slice.height >= s->img->height)
2455 height -= box_line_vwidth;
2456
2457 /* Fill background with face under the image. Do it only if row is
2458 taller than image or if image has a clip mask to reduce
2459 flickering. */
2460 s->stippled_p = s->face->stipple != 0;
2461 if (height > s->slice.height
2462 || s->img->hmargin
2463 || s->img->vmargin
2464 || s->img->mask
2465 || s->img->pixmap == 0
2466 || s->width != s->background_width)
2467 {
2468 if (s->img->mask)
2469 {
2470 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. Fill it
2471 with the background color. Copy the image to it, using
2472 its mask. Copy the temporary pixmap to the display. */
2473 Screen *screen = FRAME_X_SCREEN (s->f);
2474 int depth = DefaultDepthOfScreen (screen);
2475
2476 /* Create a pixmap as large as the glyph string. */
2477 pixmap = XCreatePixmap (s->display, s->window,
2478 s->background_width,
2479 s->height, depth);
2480
2481 /* Don't clip in the following because we're working on the
2482 pixmap. */
2483 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2484
2485 /* Fill the pixmap with the background color/stipple. */
2486 if (s->stippled_p)
2487 {
2488 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2489 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2490 XSetTSOrigin (s->display, s->gc, - s->x, - s->y);
2491 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2492 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2493 XSetFillStyle (s->display, s->gc, FillSolid);
2494 XSetTSOrigin (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0);
2495 }
2496 else
2497 {
2498 XGCValues xgcv;
2499 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground | GCBackground,
2500 &xgcv);
2501 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.background);
2502 XFillRectangle (s->display, pixmap, s->gc,
2503 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height);
2504 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2505 }
2506 }
2507 else
2508 {
2509 int x = s->x;
2510 int y = s->y;
2511
2512 if (s->first_glyph->left_box_line_p
2513 && s->slice.x == 0)
2514 x += box_line_hwidth;
2515
2516 if (s->slice.y == 0)
2517 y += box_line_vwidth;
2518
2519 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, y, s->background_width, height);
2520 }
2521
2522 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2523 }
2524
2525 /* Draw the foreground. */
2526 if (pixmap != None)
2527 {
2528 x_draw_image_foreground_1 (s, pixmap);
2529 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2530 XCopyArea (s->display, pixmap, s->window, s->gc,
2531 0, 0, s->background_width, s->height, s->x, s->y);
2532 XFreePixmap (s->display, pixmap);
2533 }
2534 else
2535 x_draw_image_foreground (s);
2536
2537 /* If we must draw a relief around the image, do it. */
2538 if (s->img->relief
2539 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_RAISED
2540 || s->hl == DRAW_IMAGE_SUNKEN)
2541 x_draw_image_relief (s);
2542 }
2543
2544
2545 /* Draw stretch glyph string S. */
2546
2547 static void
2548 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
2549 {
2550 eassert (s->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH);
2551
2552 if (s->hl == DRAW_CURSOR
2553 && !x_stretch_cursor_p)
2554 {
2555 /* If `x-stretch-cursor' is nil, don't draw a block cursor as
2556 wide as the stretch glyph. */
2557 int width, background_width = s->background_width;
2558 int x = s->x;
2559
2560 if (!s->row->reversed_p)
2561 {
2562 int left_x = window_box_left_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2563
2564 if (x < left_x)
2565 {
2566 background_width -= left_x - x;
2567 x = left_x;
2568 }
2569 }
2570 else
2571 {
2572 /* In R2L rows, draw the cursor on the right edge of the
2573 stretch glyph. */
2574 int right_x = window_box_right_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2575
2576 if (x + background_width > right_x)
2577 background_width -= x - right_x;
2578 x += background_width;
2579 }
2580 width = min (FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (s->f), background_width);
2581 if (s->row->reversed_p)
2582 x -= width;
2583
2584 /* Draw cursor. */
2585 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, s->y, width, s->height);
2586
2587 /* Clear rest using the GC of the original non-cursor face. */
2588 if (width < background_width)
2589 {
2590 int y = s->y;
2591 int w = background_width - width, h = s->height;
2592 XRectangle r;
2593 GC gc;
2594
2595 if (!s->row->reversed_p)
2596 x += width;
2597 else
2598 x = s->x;
2599 if (s->row->mouse_face_p
2600 && cursor_in_mouse_face_p (s->w))
2601 {
2602 x_set_mouse_face_gc (s);
2603 gc = s->gc;
2604 }
2605 else
2606 gc = s->face->gc;
2607
2608 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &r);
2609 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, gc, 0, 0, &r, 1, Unsorted);
2610
2611 if (s->face->stipple)
2612 {
2613 /* Fill background with a stipple pattern. */
2614 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillOpaqueStippled);
2615 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2616 XSetFillStyle (s->display, gc, FillSolid);
2617 }
2618 else
2619 {
2620 XGCValues xgcv;
2621 XGetGCValues (s->display, gc, GCForeground | GCBackground, &xgcv);
2622 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.background);
2623 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, gc, x, y, w, h);
2624 XSetForeground (s->display, gc, xgcv.foreground);
2625 }
2626 }
2627 }
2628 else if (!s->background_filled_p)
2629 {
2630 int background_width = s->background_width;
2631 int x = s->x, left_x = window_box_left_offset (s->w, TEXT_AREA);
2632
2633 /* Don't draw into left margin, fringe or scrollbar area
2634 except for header line and mode line. */
2635 if (x < left_x && !s->row->mode_line_p)
2636 {
2637 background_width -= left_x - x;
2638 x = left_x;
2639 }
2640 if (background_width > 0)
2641 x_draw_glyph_string_bg_rect (s, x, s->y, background_width, s->height);
2642 }
2643
2644 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2645 }
2646
2647 /*
2648 Draw a wavy line under S. The wave fills wave_height pixels from y0.
2649
2650 x0 wave_length = 2
2651 --
2652 y0 * * * * *
2653 |* * * * * * * * *
2654 wave_height = 3 | * * * *
2655
2656 */
2657
2658 static void
2659 x_draw_underwave (struct glyph_string *s)
2660 {
2661 int wave_height = 2, wave_length = 3;
2662 int dx, dy, x0, y0, width, x1, y1, x2, y2, odd, xmax;
2663 XRectangle wave_clip, string_clip, final_clip;
2664
2665 dx = wave_length;
2666 dy = wave_height - 1;
2667 x0 = s->x;
2668 y0 = s->ybase + 1;
2669 width = s->width;
2670 xmax = x0 + width;
2671
2672 /* Find and set clipping rectangle */
2673
2674 wave_clip = (XRectangle){ x0, y0, width, wave_height };
2675 get_glyph_string_clip_rect (s, &string_clip);
2676
2677 if (!x_intersect_rectangles (&wave_clip, &string_clip, &final_clip))
2678 return;
2679
2680 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, &final_clip, 1, Unsorted);
2681
2682 /* Draw the waves */
2683
2684 x1 = x0 - (x0 % dx);
2685 x2 = x1 + dx;
2686 odd = (x1/dx) % 2;
2687 y1 = y2 = y0;
2688
2689 if (odd)
2690 y1 += dy;
2691 else
2692 y2 += dy;
2693
2694 if (INT_MAX - dx < xmax)
2695 emacs_abort ();
2696
2697 while (x1 <= xmax)
2698 {
2699 XDrawLine (s->display, s->window, s->gc, x1, y1, x2, y2);
2700 x1 = x2, y1 = y2;
2701 x2 += dx, y2 = y0 + odd*dy;
2702 odd = !odd;
2703 }
2704
2705 /* Restore previous clipping rectangle(s) */
2706 XSetClipRectangles (s->display, s->gc, 0, 0, s->clip, s->num_clips, Unsorted);
2707 }
2708
2709
2710 /* Draw glyph string S. */
2711
2712 static void
2713 x_draw_glyph_string (struct glyph_string *s)
2714 {
2715 int relief_drawn_p = 0;
2716
2717 /* If S draws into the background of its successors, draw the
2718 background of the successors first so that S can draw into it.
2719 This makes S->next use XDrawString instead of XDrawImageString. */
2720 if (s->next && s->right_overhang && !s->for_overlaps)
2721 {
2722 int width;
2723 struct glyph_string *next;
2724
2725 for (width = 0, next = s->next;
2726 next && width < s->right_overhang;
2727 width += next->width, next = next->next)
2728 if (next->first_glyph->type != IMAGE_GLYPH)
2729 {
2730 x_set_glyph_string_gc (next);
2731 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (next);
2732 if (next->first_glyph->type == STRETCH_GLYPH)
2733 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (next);
2734 else
2735 x_draw_glyph_string_background (next, 1);
2736 next->num_clips = 0;
2737 }
2738 }
2739
2740 /* Set up S->gc, set clipping and draw S. */
2741 x_set_glyph_string_gc (s);
2742
2743 /* Draw relief (if any) in advance for char/composition so that the
2744 glyph string can be drawn over it. */
2745 if (!s->for_overlaps
2746 && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX
2747 && (s->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH
2748 || s->first_glyph->type == COMPOSITE_GLYPH))
2749
2750 {
2751 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2752 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2753 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2754 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2755 relief_drawn_p = 1;
2756 }
2757 else if (!s->clip_head /* draw_glyphs didn't specify a clip mask. */
2758 && !s->clip_tail
2759 && ((s->prev && s->prev->hl != s->hl && s->left_overhang)
2760 || (s->next && s->next->hl != s->hl && s->right_overhang)))
2761 /* We must clip just this glyph. left_overhang part has already
2762 drawn when s->prev was drawn, and right_overhang part will be
2763 drawn later when s->next is drawn. */
2764 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, s);
2765 else
2766 x_set_glyph_string_clipping (s);
2767
2768 switch (s->first_glyph->type)
2769 {
2770 case IMAGE_GLYPH:
2771 x_draw_image_glyph_string (s);
2772 break;
2773
2774 case STRETCH_GLYPH:
2775 x_draw_stretch_glyph_string (s);
2776 break;
2777
2778 case CHAR_GLYPH:
2779 if (s->for_overlaps)
2780 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2781 else
2782 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 0);
2783 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2784 break;
2785
2786 case COMPOSITE_GLYPH:
2787 if (s->for_overlaps || (s->cmp_from > 0
2788 && ! s->first_glyph->u.cmp.automatic))
2789 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2790 else
2791 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2792 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2793 break;
2794
2795 case GLYPHLESS_GLYPH:
2796 if (s->for_overlaps)
2797 s->background_filled_p = 1;
2798 else
2799 x_draw_glyph_string_background (s, 1);
2800 x_draw_glyphless_glyph_string_foreground (s);
2801 break;
2802
2803 default:
2804 emacs_abort ();
2805 }
2806
2807 if (!s->for_overlaps)
2808 {
2809 /* Draw underline. */
2810 if (s->face->underline_p)
2811 {
2812 if (s->face->underline_type == FACE_UNDER_WAVE)
2813 {
2814 if (s->face->underline_defaulted_p)
2815 x_draw_underwave (s);
2816 else
2817 {
2818 XGCValues xgcv;
2819 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2820 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->underline_color);
2821 x_draw_underwave (s);
2822 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2823 }
2824 }
2825 else if (s->face->underline_type == FACE_UNDER_LINE)
2826 {
2827 unsigned long thickness, position;
2828 int y;
2829
2830 if (s->prev && s->prev->face->underline_p)
2831 {
2832 /* We use the same underline style as the previous one. */
2833 thickness = s->prev->underline_thickness;
2834 position = s->prev->underline_position;
2835 }
2836 else
2837 {
2838 /* Get the underline thickness. Default is 1 pixel. */
2839 if (s->font && s->font->underline_thickness > 0)
2840 thickness = s->font->underline_thickness;
2841 else
2842 thickness = 1;
2843 if (x_underline_at_descent_line)
2844 position = (s->height - thickness) - (s->ybase - s->y);
2845 else
2846 {
2847 /* Get the underline position. This is the recommended
2848 vertical offset in pixels from the baseline to the top of
2849 the underline. This is a signed value according to the
2850 specs, and its default is
2851
2852 ROUND ((maximum descent) / 2), with
2853 ROUND(x) = floor (x + 0.5) */
2854
2855 if (x_use_underline_position_properties
2856 && s->font && s->font->underline_position >= 0)
2857 position = s->font->underline_position;
2858 else if (s->font)
2859 position = (s->font->descent + 1) / 2;
2860 else
2861 position = underline_minimum_offset;
2862 }
2863 position = max (position, underline_minimum_offset);
2864 }
2865 /* Check the sanity of thickness and position. We should
2866 avoid drawing underline out of the current line area. */
2867 if (s->y + s->height <= s->ybase + position)
2868 position = (s->height - 1) - (s->ybase - s->y);
2869 if (s->y + s->height < s->ybase + position + thickness)
2870 thickness = (s->y + s->height) - (s->ybase + position);
2871 s->underline_thickness = thickness;
2872 s->underline_position = position;
2873 y = s->ybase + position;
2874 if (s->face->underline_defaulted_p)
2875 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2876 s->x, y, s->width, thickness);
2877 else
2878 {
2879 XGCValues xgcv;
2880 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2881 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->underline_color);
2882 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc,
2883 s->x, y, s->width, thickness);
2884 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2885 }
2886 }
2887 }
2888 /* Draw overline. */
2889 if (s->face->overline_p)
2890 {
2891 unsigned long dy = 0, h = 1;
2892
2893 if (s->face->overline_color_defaulted_p)
2894 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2895 s->width, h);
2896 else
2897 {
2898 XGCValues xgcv;
2899 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2900 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->overline_color);
2901 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2902 s->width, h);
2903 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2904 }
2905 }
2906
2907 /* Draw strike-through. */
2908 if (s->face->strike_through_p)
2909 {
2910 unsigned long h = 1;
2911 unsigned long dy = (s->height - h) / 2;
2912
2913 if (s->face->strike_through_color_defaulted_p)
2914 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2915 s->width, h);
2916 else
2917 {
2918 XGCValues xgcv;
2919 XGetGCValues (s->display, s->gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
2920 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, s->face->strike_through_color);
2921 XFillRectangle (s->display, s->window, s->gc, s->x, s->y + dy,
2922 s->width, h);
2923 XSetForeground (s->display, s->gc, xgcv.foreground);
2924 }
2925 }
2926
2927 /* Draw relief if not yet drawn. */
2928 if (!relief_drawn_p && s->face->box != FACE_NO_BOX)
2929 x_draw_glyph_string_box (s);
2930
2931 if (s->prev)
2932 {
2933 struct glyph_string *prev;
2934
2935 for (prev = s->prev; prev; prev = prev->prev)
2936 if (prev->hl != s->hl
2937 && prev->x + prev->width + prev->right_overhang > s->x)
2938 {
2939 /* As prev was drawn while clipped to its own area, we
2940 must draw the right_overhang part using s->hl now. */
2941 enum draw_glyphs_face save = prev->hl;
2942
2943 prev->hl = s->hl;
2944 x_set_glyph_string_gc (prev);
2945 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, prev);
2946 if (prev->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
2947 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (prev);
2948 else
2949 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (prev);
2950 XSetClipMask (prev->display, prev->gc, None);
2951 prev->hl = save;
2952 prev->num_clips = 0;
2953 }
2954 }
2955
2956 if (s->next)
2957 {
2958 struct glyph_string *next;
2959
2960 for (next = s->next; next; next = next->next)
2961 if (next->hl != s->hl
2962 && next->x - next->left_overhang < s->x + s->width)
2963 {
2964 /* As next will be drawn while clipped to its own area,
2965 we must draw the left_overhang part using s->hl now. */
2966 enum draw_glyphs_face save = next->hl;
2967
2968 next->hl = s->hl;
2969 x_set_glyph_string_gc (next);
2970 x_set_glyph_string_clipping_exactly (s, next);
2971 if (next->first_glyph->type == CHAR_GLYPH)
2972 x_draw_glyph_string_foreground (next);
2973 else
2974 x_draw_composite_glyph_string_foreground (next);
2975 XSetClipMask (next->display, next->gc, None);
2976 next->hl = save;
2977 next->num_clips = 0;
2978 next->clip_head = s->next;
2979 }
2980 }
2981 }
2982
2983 /* Reset clipping. */
2984 XSetClipMask (s->display, s->gc, None);
2985 s->num_clips = 0;
2986 }
2987
2988 /* Shift display to make room for inserted glyphs. */
2989
2990 static void
2991 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert (struct frame *f, int x, int y, int width, int height, int shift_by)
2992 {
2993 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
2994 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
2995 x, y, width, height,
2996 x + shift_by, y);
2997 }
2998
2999 /* Delete N glyphs at the nominal cursor position. Not implemented
3000 for X frames. */
3001
3002 static void
3003 x_delete_glyphs (struct frame *f, register int n)
3004 {
3005 emacs_abort ();
3006 }
3007
3008
3009 /* Like XClearArea, but check that WIDTH and HEIGHT are reasonable.
3010 If they are <= 0, this is probably an error. */
3011
3012 void
3013 x_clear_area (Display *dpy, Window window, int x, int y, int width, int height, int exposures)
3014 {
3015 eassert (width > 0 && height > 0);
3016 XClearArea (dpy, window, x, y, width, height, exposures);
3017 }
3018
3019
3020 /* Clear an entire frame. */
3021
3022 static void
3023 x_clear_frame (struct frame *f)
3024 {
3025 /* Clearing the frame will erase any cursor, so mark them all as no
3026 longer visible. */
3027 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (FRAME_ROOT_WINDOW (f)));
3028 output_cursor.hpos = output_cursor.vpos = 0;
3029 output_cursor.x = -1;
3030
3031 /* We don't set the output cursor here because there will always
3032 follow an explicit cursor_to. */
3033 BLOCK_INPUT;
3034
3035 XClearWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
3036
3037 /* We have to clear the scroll bars. If we have changed colors or
3038 something like that, then they should be notified. */
3039 x_scroll_bar_clear (f);
3040
3041 #if defined (USE_GTK) && defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS)
3042 /* Make sure scroll bars are redrawn. As they aren't redrawn by
3043 redisplay, do it here. */
3044 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
3045 gtk_widget_queue_draw (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
3046 #endif
3047
3048 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3049
3050 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3051 }
3052
3053
3054 \f
3055 /* Invert the middle quarter of the frame for .15 sec. */
3056
3057 static void
3058 XTflash (struct frame *f)
3059 {
3060 BLOCK_INPUT;
3061
3062 {
3063 #ifdef USE_GTK
3064 /* Use Gdk routines to draw. This way, we won't draw over scroll bars
3065 when the scroll bars and the edit widget share the same X window. */
3066 GdkWindow *window = gtk_widget_get_window (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
3067 #ifdef HAVE_GTK3
3068 cairo_t *cr = gdk_cairo_create (window);
3069 cairo_set_source_rgb (cr, 1, 1, 1);
3070 cairo_set_operator (cr, CAIRO_OPERATOR_DIFFERENCE);
3071 #define XFillRectangle(d, win, gc, x, y, w, h) \
3072 do { \
3073 cairo_rectangle (cr, x, y, w, h); \
3074 cairo_fill (cr); \
3075 } \
3076 while (0)
3077 #else /* ! HAVE_GTK3 */
3078 GdkGCValues vals;
3079 GdkGC *gc;
3080 vals.foreground.pixel = (FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f)
3081 ^ FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
3082 vals.function = GDK_XOR;
3083 gc = gdk_gc_new_with_values (window,
3084 &vals, GDK_GC_FUNCTION | GDK_GC_FOREGROUND);
3085 #define XFillRectangle(d, win, gc, x, y, w, h) \
3086 gdk_draw_rectangle (window, gc, TRUE, x, y, w, h)
3087 #endif /* ! HAVE_GTK3 */
3088 #else /* ! USE_GTK */
3089 GC gc;
3090
3091 /* Create a GC that will use the GXxor function to flip foreground
3092 pixels into background pixels. */
3093 {
3094 XGCValues values;
3095
3096 values.function = GXxor;
3097 values.foreground = (FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f)
3098 ^ FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
3099
3100 gc = XCreateGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3101 GCFunction | GCForeground, &values);
3102 }
3103 #endif
3104 {
3105 /* Get the height not including a menu bar widget. */
3106 int height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, FRAME_LINES (f));
3107 /* Height of each line to flash. */
3108 int flash_height = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
3109 /* These will be the left and right margins of the rectangles. */
3110 int flash_left = FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
3111 int flash_right = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f);
3112
3113 int width;
3114
3115 /* Don't flash the area between a scroll bar and the frame
3116 edge it is next to. */
3117 switch (FRAME_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TYPE (f))
3118 {
3119 case vertical_scroll_bar_left:
3120 flash_left += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
3121 break;
3122
3123 case vertical_scroll_bar_right:
3124 flash_right -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
3125 break;
3126
3127 default:
3128 break;
3129 }
3130
3131 width = flash_right - flash_left;
3132
3133 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
3134 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
3135 {
3136 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3137 flash_left,
3138 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
3139 + FRAME_TOP_MARGIN_HEIGHT (f)),
3140 width, flash_height);
3141 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3142 flash_left,
3143 (height - flash_height
3144 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
3145 width, flash_height);
3146
3147 }
3148 else
3149 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
3150 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3151 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
3152 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
3153
3154 x_flush (f);
3155
3156 {
3157 EMACS_TIME delay = make_emacs_time (0, 150 * 1000 * 1000);
3158 EMACS_TIME wakeup = add_emacs_time (current_emacs_time (), delay);
3159
3160 /* Keep waiting until past the time wakeup or any input gets
3161 available. */
3162 while (! detect_input_pending ())
3163 {
3164 EMACS_TIME current = current_emacs_time ();
3165 EMACS_TIME timeout;
3166
3167 /* Break if result would not be positive. */
3168 if (EMACS_TIME_LE (wakeup, current))
3169 break;
3170
3171 /* How long `select' should wait. */
3172 timeout = make_emacs_time (0, 10 * 1000 * 1000);
3173
3174 /* Try to wait that long--but we might wake up sooner. */
3175 pselect (0, NULL, NULL, NULL, &timeout, NULL);
3176 }
3177 }
3178
3179 /* If window is tall, flash top and bottom line. */
3180 if (height > 3 * FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f))
3181 {
3182 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3183 flash_left,
3184 (FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)
3185 + FRAME_TOP_MARGIN_HEIGHT (f)),
3186 width, flash_height);
3187 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3188 flash_left,
3189 (height - flash_height
3190 - FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f)),
3191 width, flash_height);
3192 }
3193 else
3194 /* If it is short, flash it all. */
3195 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc,
3196 flash_left, FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f),
3197 width, height - 2 * FRAME_INTERNAL_BORDER_WIDTH (f));
3198
3199 #ifdef USE_GTK
3200 #ifdef HAVE_GTK3
3201 cairo_destroy (cr);
3202 #else
3203 g_object_unref (G_OBJECT (gc));
3204 #endif
3205 #undef XFillRectangle
3206 #else
3207 XFreeGC (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc);
3208 #endif
3209 x_flush (f);
3210 }
3211 }
3212
3213 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3214 }
3215
3216
3217 static void
3218 XTtoggle_invisible_pointer (FRAME_PTR f, int invisible)
3219 {
3220 BLOCK_INPUT;
3221 if (invisible)
3222 {
3223 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->invisible_cursor != 0)
3224 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3225 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->invisible_cursor);
3226 }
3227 else
3228 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3229 f->output_data.x->current_cursor);
3230 f->pointer_invisible = invisible;
3231 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3232 }
3233
3234
3235 /* Make audible bell. */
3236
3237 static void
3238 XTring_bell (struct frame *f)
3239 {
3240 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))
3241 {
3242 if (visible_bell)
3243 XTflash (f);
3244 else
3245 {
3246 BLOCK_INPUT;
3247 XBell (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), 0);
3248 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3249 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3250 }
3251 }
3252 }
3253
3254 \f
3255 /* Specify how many text lines, from the top of the window,
3256 should be affected by insert-lines and delete-lines operations.
3257 This, and those operations, are used only within an update
3258 that is bounded by calls to x_update_begin and x_update_end. */
3259
3260 static void
3261 XTset_terminal_window (struct frame *f, int n)
3262 {
3263 /* This function intentionally left blank. */
3264 }
3265
3266
3267 \f
3268 /***********************************************************************
3269 Line Dance
3270 ***********************************************************************/
3271
3272 /* Perform an insert-lines or delete-lines operation, inserting N
3273 lines or deleting -N lines at vertical position VPOS. */
3274
3275 static void
3276 x_ins_del_lines (struct frame *f, int vpos, int n)
3277 {
3278 emacs_abort ();
3279 }
3280
3281
3282 /* Scroll part of the display as described by RUN. */
3283
3284 static void
3285 x_scroll_run (struct window *w, struct run *run)
3286 {
3287 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
3288 int x, y, width, height, from_y, to_y, bottom_y;
3289
3290 /* Get frame-relative bounding box of the text display area of W,
3291 without mode lines. Include in this box the left and right
3292 fringe of W. */
3293 window_box (w, -1, &x, &y, &width, &height);
3294
3295 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
3296 /* If the fringe is adjacent to the left (right) scroll bar of a
3297 leftmost (rightmost, respectively) window, then extend its
3298 background to the gap between the fringe and the bar. */
3299 if ((WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
3300 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
3301 || (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
3302 && WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w)))
3303 {
3304 int sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
3305
3306 if (sb_width > 0)
3307 {
3308 int bar_area_x = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
3309 int bar_area_width = (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w)
3310 * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f));
3311
3312 if (bar_area_x + bar_area_width == x)
3313 {
3314 x = bar_area_x + sb_width;
3315 width += bar_area_width - sb_width;
3316 }
3317 else if (x + width == bar_area_x)
3318 width += bar_area_width - sb_width;
3319 }
3320 }
3321 #endif
3322
3323 from_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->current_y);
3324 to_y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, run->desired_y);
3325 bottom_y = y + height;
3326
3327 if (to_y < from_y)
3328 {
3329 /* Scrolling up. Make sure we don't copy part of the mode
3330 line at the bottom. */
3331 if (from_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3332 height = bottom_y - from_y;
3333 else
3334 height = run->height;
3335 }
3336 else
3337 {
3338 /* Scrolling down. Make sure we don't copy over the mode line.
3339 at the bottom. */
3340 if (to_y + run->height > bottom_y)
3341 height = bottom_y - to_y;
3342 else
3343 height = run->height;
3344 }
3345
3346 BLOCK_INPUT;
3347
3348 /* Cursor off. Will be switched on again in x_update_window_end. */
3349 updated_window = w;
3350 x_clear_cursor (w);
3351
3352 XCopyArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
3353 FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3354 f->output_data.x->normal_gc,
3355 x, from_y,
3356 width, height,
3357 x, to_y);
3358
3359 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3360 }
3361
3362
3363 \f
3364 /***********************************************************************
3365 Exposure Events
3366 ***********************************************************************/
3367
3368 \f
3369 static void
3370 frame_highlight (struct frame *f)
3371 {
3372 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3373 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3374 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3375 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3376 BLOCK_INPUT;
3377 /* I recently started to get errors in this XSetWindowBorder, depending on
3378 the window-manager in use, tho something more is at play since I've been
3379 using that same window-manager binary for ever. Let's not crash just
3380 because of this (bug#9310). */
3381 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3382 XSetWindowBorder (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3383 f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
3384 x_uncatch_errors ();
3385 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3386 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3387 x_set_frame_alpha (f);
3388 }
3389
3390 static void
3391 frame_unhighlight (struct frame *f)
3392 {
3393 /* We used to only do this if Vx_no_window_manager was non-nil, but
3394 the ICCCM (section 4.1.6) says that the window's border pixmap
3395 and border pixel are window attributes which are "private to the
3396 client", so we can always change it to whatever we want. */
3397 BLOCK_INPUT;
3398 /* Same as above for XSetWindowBorder (bug#9310). */
3399 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
3400 XSetWindowBorderPixmap (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
3401 f->output_data.x->border_tile);
3402 x_uncatch_errors ();
3403 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3404 x_update_cursor (f, 1);
3405 x_set_frame_alpha (f);
3406 }
3407
3408 /* The focus has changed. Update the frames as necessary to reflect
3409 the new situation. Note that we can't change the selected frame
3410 here, because the Lisp code we are interrupting might become confused.
3411 Each event gets marked with the frame in which it occurred, so the
3412 Lisp code can tell when the switch took place by examining the events. */
3413
3414 static void
3415 x_new_focus_frame (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, struct frame *frame)
3416 {
3417 struct frame *old_focus = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3418
3419 if (frame != dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3420 {
3421 /* Set this before calling other routines, so that they see
3422 the correct value of x_focus_frame. */
3423 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = frame;
3424
3425 if (old_focus && old_focus->auto_lower)
3426 x_lower_frame (old_focus);
3427
3428 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame && dpyinfo->x_focus_frame->auto_raise)
3429 pending_autoraise_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3430 else
3431 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
3432 }
3433
3434 x_frame_rehighlight (dpyinfo);
3435 }
3436
3437 /* Handle FocusIn and FocusOut state changes for FRAME.
3438 If FRAME has focus and there exists more than one frame, puts
3439 a FOCUS_IN_EVENT into *BUFP. */
3440
3441 static void
3442 x_focus_changed (int type, int state, struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, struct frame *frame, struct input_event *bufp)
3443 {
3444 if (type == FocusIn)
3445 {
3446 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame != frame)
3447 {
3448 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, frame);
3449 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = frame;
3450
3451 /* Don't stop displaying the initial startup message
3452 for a switch-frame event we don't need. */
3453 if (NILP (Vterminal_frame)
3454 && CONSP (Vframe_list)
3455 && !NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
3456 {
3457 bufp->kind = FOCUS_IN_EVENT;
3458 XSETFRAME (bufp->frame_or_window, frame);
3459 }
3460 }
3461
3462 frame->output_data.x->focus_state |= state;
3463
3464 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3465 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3466 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3467 #endif
3468 }
3469 else if (type == FocusOut)
3470 {
3471 frame->output_data.x->focus_state &= ~state;
3472
3473 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame == frame)
3474 {
3475 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
3476 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, 0);
3477 }
3478
3479 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
3480 if (FRAME_XIC (frame))
3481 XUnsetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (frame));
3482 #endif
3483 if (frame->pointer_invisible)
3484 XTtoggle_invisible_pointer (frame, 0);
3485 }
3486 }
3487
3488 /* The focus may have changed. Figure out if it is a real focus change,
3489 by checking both FocusIn/Out and Enter/LeaveNotify events.
3490
3491 Returns FOCUS_IN_EVENT event in *BUFP. */
3492
3493 static void
3494 x_detect_focus_change (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, XEvent *event, struct input_event *bufp)
3495 {
3496 struct frame *frame;
3497
3498 frame = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event->xany.window);
3499 if (! frame)
3500 return;
3501
3502 switch (event->type)
3503 {
3504 case EnterNotify:
3505 case LeaveNotify:
3506 {
3507 struct frame *focus_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame;
3508 int focus_state
3509 = focus_frame ? focus_frame->output_data.x->focus_state : 0;
3510
3511 if (event->xcrossing.detail != NotifyInferior
3512 && event->xcrossing.focus
3513 && ! (focus_state & FOCUS_EXPLICIT))
3514 x_focus_changed ((event->type == EnterNotify ? FocusIn : FocusOut),
3515 FOCUS_IMPLICIT,
3516 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3517 }
3518 break;
3519
3520 case FocusIn:
3521 case FocusOut:
3522 x_focus_changed (event->type,
3523 (event->xfocus.detail == NotifyPointer ?
3524 FOCUS_IMPLICIT : FOCUS_EXPLICIT),
3525 dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3526 break;
3527
3528 case ClientMessage:
3529 if (event->xclient.message_type == dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED)
3530 {
3531 enum xembed_message msg = event->xclient.data.l[1];
3532 x_focus_changed ((msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_IN ? FocusIn : FocusOut),
3533 FOCUS_EXPLICIT, dpyinfo, frame, bufp);
3534 }
3535 break;
3536 }
3537 }
3538
3539
3540 #if defined HAVE_MENUS && !defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && !defined USE_GTK
3541 /* Handle an event saying the mouse has moved out of an Emacs frame. */
3542
3543 void
3544 x_mouse_leave (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
3545 {
3546 x_new_focus_frame (dpyinfo, dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame);
3547 }
3548 #endif
3549
3550 /* The focus has changed, or we have redirected a frame's focus to
3551 another frame (this happens when a frame uses a surrogate
3552 mini-buffer frame). Shift the highlight as appropriate.
3553
3554 The FRAME argument doesn't necessarily have anything to do with which
3555 frame is being highlighted or un-highlighted; we only use it to find
3556 the appropriate X display info. */
3557
3558 static void
3559 XTframe_rehighlight (struct frame *frame)
3560 {
3561 x_frame_rehighlight (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (frame));
3562 }
3563
3564 static void
3565 x_frame_rehighlight (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
3566 {
3567 struct frame *old_highlight = dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame;
3568
3569 if (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
3570 {
3571 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame
3572 = ((FRAMEP (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)))
3573 ? XFRAME (FRAME_FOCUS_FRAME (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame))
3574 : dpyinfo->x_focus_frame);
3575 if (! FRAME_LIVE_P (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame))
3576 {
3577 fset_focus_frame (dpyinfo->x_focus_frame, Qnil);
3578 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = dpyinfo->x_focus_frame;
3579 }
3580 }
3581 else
3582 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
3583
3584 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame != old_highlight)
3585 {
3586 if (old_highlight)
3587 frame_unhighlight (old_highlight);
3588 if (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
3589 frame_highlight (dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame);
3590 }
3591 }
3592
3593
3594 \f
3595 /* Keyboard processing - modifier keys, vendor-specific keysyms, etc. */
3596
3597 /* Initialize mode_switch_bit and modifier_meaning. */
3598 static void
3599 x_find_modifier_meanings (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
3600 {
3601 int min_code, max_code;
3602 KeySym *syms;
3603 int syms_per_code;
3604 XModifierKeymap *mods;
3605
3606 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = 0;
3607 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = 0;
3608 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3609 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask = 0;
3610 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask = 0;
3611
3612 XDisplayKeycodes (dpyinfo->display, &min_code, &max_code);
3613
3614 syms = XGetKeyboardMapping (dpyinfo->display,
3615 min_code, max_code - min_code + 1,
3616 &syms_per_code);
3617 mods = XGetModifierMapping (dpyinfo->display);
3618
3619 /* Scan the modifier table to see which modifier bits the Meta and
3620 Alt keysyms are on. */
3621 {
3622 int row, col; /* The row and column in the modifier table. */
3623 int found_alt_or_meta;
3624
3625 for (row = 3; row < 8; row++)
3626 {
3627 found_alt_or_meta = 0;
3628 for (col = 0; col < mods->max_keypermod; col++)
3629 {
3630 KeyCode code = mods->modifiermap[(row * mods->max_keypermod) + col];
3631
3632 /* Zeroes are used for filler. Skip them. */
3633 if (code == 0)
3634 continue;
3635
3636 /* Are any of this keycode's keysyms a meta key? */
3637 {
3638 int code_col;
3639
3640 for (code_col = 0; code_col < syms_per_code; code_col++)
3641 {
3642 int sym = syms[((code - min_code) * syms_per_code) + code_col];
3643
3644 switch (sym)
3645 {
3646 case XK_Meta_L:
3647 case XK_Meta_R:
3648 found_alt_or_meta = 1;
3649 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3650 break;
3651
3652 case XK_Alt_L:
3653 case XK_Alt_R:
3654 found_alt_or_meta = 1;
3655 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3656 break;
3657
3658 case XK_Hyper_L:
3659 case XK_Hyper_R:
3660 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
3661 dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3662 code_col = syms_per_code;
3663 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3664 break;
3665
3666 case XK_Super_L:
3667 case XK_Super_R:
3668 if (!found_alt_or_meta)
3669 dpyinfo->super_mod_mask |= (1 << row);
3670 code_col = syms_per_code;
3671 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3672 break;
3673
3674 case XK_Shift_Lock:
3675 /* Ignore this if it's not on the lock modifier. */
3676 if (!found_alt_or_meta && ((1 << row) == LockMask))
3677 dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask = LockMask;
3678 code_col = syms_per_code;
3679 col = mods->max_keypermod;
3680 break;
3681 }
3682 }
3683 }
3684 }
3685 }
3686 }
3687
3688 /* If we couldn't find any meta keys, accept any alt keys as meta keys. */
3689 if (! dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3690 {
3691 dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask = dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask;
3692 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask = 0;
3693 }
3694
3695 /* If some keys are both alt and meta,
3696 make them just meta, not alt. */
3697 if (dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
3698 {
3699 dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask &= ~dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask;
3700 }
3701
3702 XFree (syms);
3703 XFreeModifiermap (mods);
3704 }
3705
3706 /* Convert between the modifier bits X uses and the modifier bits
3707 Emacs uses. */
3708
3709 int
3710 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, int state)
3711 {
3712 int mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3713 int mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3714 int mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3715 int mod_super = super_modifier;
3716 Lisp_Object tem;
3717
3718 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3719 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_alt = XINT (tem) & INT_MAX;
3720 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3721 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_meta = XINT (tem) & INT_MAX;
3722 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3723 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_hyper = XINT (tem) & INT_MAX;
3724 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3725 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_super = XINT (tem) & INT_MAX;
3726
3727 return ( ((state & (ShiftMask | dpyinfo->shift_lock_mask)) ? shift_modifier : 0)
3728 | ((state & ControlMask) ? ctrl_modifier : 0)
3729 | ((state & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask) ? mod_meta : 0)
3730 | ((state & dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask) ? mod_alt : 0)
3731 | ((state & dpyinfo->super_mod_mask) ? mod_super : 0)
3732 | ((state & dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask) ? mod_hyper : 0));
3733 }
3734
3735 static int
3736 x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, EMACS_INT state)
3737 {
3738 EMACS_INT mod_meta = meta_modifier;
3739 EMACS_INT mod_alt = alt_modifier;
3740 EMACS_INT mod_hyper = hyper_modifier;
3741 EMACS_INT mod_super = super_modifier;
3742
3743 Lisp_Object tem;
3744
3745 tem = Fget (Vx_alt_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3746 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_alt = XINT (tem);
3747 tem = Fget (Vx_meta_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3748 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_meta = XINT (tem);
3749 tem = Fget (Vx_hyper_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3750 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_hyper = XINT (tem);
3751 tem = Fget (Vx_super_keysym, Qmodifier_value);
3752 if (INTEGERP (tem)) mod_super = XINT (tem);
3753
3754
3755 return ( ((state & mod_alt) ? dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask : 0)
3756 | ((state & mod_super) ? dpyinfo->super_mod_mask : 0)
3757 | ((state & mod_hyper) ? dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask : 0)
3758 | ((state & shift_modifier) ? ShiftMask : 0)
3759 | ((state & ctrl_modifier) ? ControlMask : 0)
3760 | ((state & mod_meta) ? dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask : 0));
3761 }
3762
3763 /* Convert a keysym to its name. */
3764
3765 char *
3766 x_get_keysym_name (int keysym)
3767 {
3768 char *value;
3769
3770 BLOCK_INPUT;
3771 value = XKeysymToString (keysym);
3772 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
3773
3774 return value;
3775 }
3776
3777
3778 \f
3779 /* Mouse clicks and mouse movement. Rah. */
3780
3781 /* Prepare a mouse-event in *RESULT for placement in the input queue.
3782
3783 If the event is a button press, then note that we have grabbed
3784 the mouse. */
3785
3786 static Lisp_Object
3787 construct_mouse_click (struct input_event *result, XButtonEvent *event, struct frame *f)
3788 {
3789 /* Make the event type NO_EVENT; we'll change that when we decide
3790 otherwise. */
3791 result->kind = MOUSE_CLICK_EVENT;
3792 result->code = event->button - Button1;
3793 result->timestamp = event->time;
3794 result->modifiers = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
3795 event->state)
3796 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
3797 ? up_modifier
3798 : down_modifier));
3799
3800 XSETINT (result->x, event->x);
3801 XSETINT (result->y, event->y);
3802 XSETFRAME (result->frame_or_window, f);
3803 result->arg = Qnil;
3804 return Qnil;
3805 }
3806
3807 \f
3808 /* Function to report a mouse movement to the mainstream Emacs code.
3809 The input handler calls this.
3810
3811 We have received a mouse movement event, which is given in *event.
3812 If the mouse is over a different glyph than it was last time, tell
3813 the mainstream emacs code by setting mouse_moved. If not, ask for
3814 another motion event, so we can check again the next time it moves. */
3815
3816 static XMotionEvent last_mouse_motion_event;
3817 static Lisp_Object last_mouse_motion_frame;
3818
3819 static int
3820 note_mouse_movement (FRAME_PTR frame, XMotionEvent *event)
3821 {
3822 last_mouse_movement_time = event->time;
3823 last_mouse_motion_event = *event;
3824 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame, frame);
3825
3826 if (!FRAME_X_OUTPUT (frame))
3827 return 0;
3828
3829 if (event->window != FRAME_X_WINDOW (frame))
3830 {
3831 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3832 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3833 note_mouse_highlight (frame, -1, -1);
3834 last_mouse_glyph_frame = 0;
3835 return 1;
3836 }
3837
3838
3839 /* Has the mouse moved off the glyph it was on at the last sighting? */
3840 if (frame != last_mouse_glyph_frame
3841 || event->x < last_mouse_glyph.x
3842 || event->x >= last_mouse_glyph.x + last_mouse_glyph.width
3843 || event->y < last_mouse_glyph.y
3844 || event->y >= last_mouse_glyph.y + last_mouse_glyph.height)
3845 {
3846 frame->mouse_moved = 1;
3847 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3848 note_mouse_highlight (frame, event->x, event->y);
3849 /* Remember which glyph we're now on. */
3850 remember_mouse_glyph (frame, event->x, event->y, &last_mouse_glyph);
3851 last_mouse_glyph_frame = frame;
3852 return 1;
3853 }
3854
3855 return 0;
3856 }
3857
3858 \f
3859 /************************************************************************
3860 Mouse Face
3861 ************************************************************************/
3862
3863 static void
3864 redo_mouse_highlight (void)
3865 {
3866 if (!NILP (last_mouse_motion_frame)
3867 && FRAME_LIVE_P (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame)))
3868 note_mouse_highlight (XFRAME (last_mouse_motion_frame),
3869 last_mouse_motion_event.x,
3870 last_mouse_motion_event.y);
3871 }
3872
3873
3874
3875 /* Return the current position of the mouse.
3876 *FP should be a frame which indicates which display to ask about.
3877
3878 If the mouse movement started in a scroll bar, set *FP, *BAR_WINDOW,
3879 and *PART to the frame, window, and scroll bar part that the mouse
3880 is over. Set *X and *Y to the portion and whole of the mouse's
3881 position on the scroll bar.
3882
3883 If the mouse movement started elsewhere, set *FP to the frame the
3884 mouse is on, *BAR_WINDOW to nil, and *X and *Y to the character cell
3885 the mouse is over.
3886
3887 Set *TIMESTAMP to the server time-stamp for the time at which the mouse
3888 was at this position.
3889
3890 Don't store anything if we don't have a valid set of values to report.
3891
3892 This clears the mouse_moved flag, so we can wait for the next mouse
3893 movement. */
3894
3895 static void
3896 XTmouse_position (FRAME_PTR *fp, int insist, Lisp_Object *bar_window,
3897 enum scroll_bar_part *part, Lisp_Object *x, Lisp_Object *y,
3898 Time *timestamp)
3899 {
3900 FRAME_PTR f1;
3901
3902 BLOCK_INPUT;
3903
3904 if (! NILP (last_mouse_scroll_bar) && insist == 0)
3905 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (fp, bar_window, part, x, y, timestamp);
3906 else
3907 {
3908 Window root;
3909 int root_x, root_y;
3910
3911 Window dummy_window;
3912 int dummy;
3913
3914 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
3915
3916 /* Clear the mouse-moved flag for every frame on this display. */
3917 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
3918 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
3919 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp))
3920 XFRAME (frame)->mouse_moved = 0;
3921
3922 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
3923
3924 /* Figure out which root window we're on. */
3925 XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3926 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)),
3927
3928 /* The root window which contains the pointer. */
3929 &root,
3930
3931 /* Trash which we can't trust if the pointer is on
3932 a different screen. */
3933 &dummy_window,
3934
3935 /* The position on that root window. */
3936 &root_x, &root_y,
3937
3938 /* More trash we can't trust. */
3939 &dummy, &dummy,
3940
3941 /* Modifier keys and pointer buttons, about which
3942 we don't care. */
3943 (unsigned int *) &dummy);
3944
3945 /* Now we have a position on the root; find the innermost window
3946 containing the pointer. */
3947 {
3948 Window win, child;
3949 int win_x, win_y;
3950 int parent_x = 0, parent_y = 0;
3951
3952 win = root;
3953
3954 /* XTranslateCoordinates can get errors if the window
3955 structure is changing at the same time this function
3956 is running. So at least we must not crash from them. */
3957
3958 x_catch_errors (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp));
3959
3960 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp)->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
3961 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
3962 {
3963 /* If mouse was grabbed on a frame, give coords for that frame
3964 even if the mouse is now outside it. */
3965 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3966
3967 /* From-window, to-window. */
3968 root, FRAME_X_WINDOW (last_mouse_frame),
3969
3970 /* From-position, to-position. */
3971 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
3972
3973 /* Child of win. */
3974 &child);
3975 f1 = last_mouse_frame;
3976 }
3977 else
3978 {
3979 while (1)
3980 {
3981 XTranslateCoordinates (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp),
3982
3983 /* From-window, to-window. */
3984 root, win,
3985
3986 /* From-position, to-position. */
3987 root_x, root_y, &win_x, &win_y,
3988
3989 /* Child of win. */
3990 &child);
3991
3992 if (child == None || child == win)
3993 break;
3994 #ifdef USE_GTK
3995 /* We don't wan't to know the innermost window. We
3996 want the edit window. For non-Gtk+ the innermost
3997 window is the edit window. For Gtk+ it might not
3998 be. It might be the tool bar for example. */
3999 if (x_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win))
4000 break;
4001 #endif
4002 win = child;
4003 parent_x = win_x;
4004 parent_y = win_y;
4005 }
4006
4007 /* Now we know that:
4008 win is the innermost window containing the pointer
4009 (XTC says it has no child containing the pointer),
4010 win_x and win_y are the pointer's position in it
4011 (XTC did this the last time through), and
4012 parent_x and parent_y are the pointer's position in win's parent.
4013 (They are what win_x and win_y were when win was child.
4014 If win is the root window, it has no parent, and
4015 parent_{x,y} are invalid, but that's okay, because we'll
4016 never use them in that case.) */
4017
4018 #ifdef USE_GTK
4019 /* We don't wan't to know the innermost window. We
4020 want the edit window. */
4021 f1 = x_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win);
4022 #else
4023 /* Is win one of our frames? */
4024 f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (*fp), win);
4025 #endif
4026
4027 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
4028 /* If we end up with the menu bar window, say it's not
4029 on the frame. */
4030 if (f1 != NULL
4031 && f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget
4032 && win == XtWindow (f1->output_data.x->menubar_widget))
4033 f1 = NULL;
4034 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
4035 }
4036
4037 if (x_had_errors_p (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp)))
4038 f1 = 0;
4039
4040 x_uncatch_errors ();
4041
4042 /* If not, is it one of our scroll bars? */
4043 if (! f1)
4044 {
4045 struct scroll_bar *bar;
4046
4047 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (*fp), win);
4048
4049 if (bar)
4050 {
4051 f1 = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4052 win_x = parent_x;
4053 win_y = parent_y;
4054 }
4055 }
4056
4057 if (f1 == 0 && insist > 0)
4058 f1 = SELECTED_FRAME ();
4059
4060 if (f1)
4061 {
4062 /* Ok, we found a frame. Store all the values.
4063 last_mouse_glyph is a rectangle used to reduce the
4064 generation of mouse events. To not miss any motion
4065 events, we must divide the frame into rectangles of the
4066 size of the smallest character that could be displayed
4067 on it, i.e. into the same rectangles that matrices on
4068 the frame are divided into. */
4069
4070 remember_mouse_glyph (f1, win_x, win_y, &last_mouse_glyph);
4071 last_mouse_glyph_frame = f1;
4072
4073 *bar_window = Qnil;
4074 *part = 0;
4075 *fp = f1;
4076 XSETINT (*x, win_x);
4077 XSETINT (*y, win_y);
4078 *timestamp = last_mouse_movement_time;
4079 }
4080 }
4081 }
4082
4083 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4084 }
4085
4086
4087 \f
4088 /***********************************************************************
4089 Scroll bars
4090 ***********************************************************************/
4091
4092 /* Scroll bar support. */
4093
4094 /* Given an X window ID and a DISPLAY, find the struct scroll_bar which
4095 manages it.
4096 This can be called in GC, so we have to make sure to strip off mark
4097 bits. */
4098
4099 static struct scroll_bar *
4100 x_window_to_scroll_bar (Display *display, Window window_id)
4101 {
4102 Lisp_Object tail;
4103
4104 #if defined (USE_GTK) && defined (USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS)
4105 window_id = (Window) xg_get_scroll_id_for_window (display, window_id);
4106 #endif /* USE_GTK && USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4107
4108 for (tail = Vframe_list; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
4109 {
4110 Lisp_Object frame, bar, condemned;
4111
4112 frame = XCAR (tail);
4113 /* All elements of Vframe_list should be frames. */
4114 if (! FRAMEP (frame))
4115 emacs_abort ();
4116
4117 if (! FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame)))
4118 continue;
4119
4120 /* Scan this frame's scroll bar list for a scroll bar with the
4121 right window ID. */
4122 condemned = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
4123 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (XFRAME (frame));
4124 /* This trick allows us to search both the ordinary and
4125 condemned scroll bar lists with one loop. */
4126 ! NILP (bar) || (bar = condemned,
4127 condemned = Qnil,
4128 ! NILP (bar));
4129 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
4130 if (XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->x_window == window_id &&
4131 FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (frame)) == display)
4132 return XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
4133 }
4134
4135 return NULL;
4136 }
4137
4138
4139 #if defined USE_LUCID
4140
4141 /* Return the Lucid menu bar WINDOW is part of. Return null
4142 if WINDOW is not part of a menu bar. */
4143
4144 static Widget
4145 x_window_to_menu_bar (Window window)
4146 {
4147 Lisp_Object tail;
4148
4149 for (tail = Vframe_list; CONSP (tail); tail = XCDR (tail))
4150 {
4151 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (XCAR (tail))))
4152 {
4153 Lisp_Object frame = XCAR (tail);
4154 Widget menu_bar = XFRAME (frame)->output_data.x->menubar_widget;
4155
4156 if (menu_bar && xlwmenu_window_p (menu_bar, window))
4157 return menu_bar;
4158 }
4159 }
4160
4161 return NULL;
4162 }
4163
4164 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
4165
4166 \f
4167 /************************************************************************
4168 Toolkit scroll bars
4169 ************************************************************************/
4170
4171 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4172
4173 static void x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (XEvent *, struct input_event *);
4174 static void x_send_scroll_bar_event (Lisp_Object, int, int, int);
4175 static void x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *,
4176 struct scroll_bar *);
4177 static void x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *,
4178 int, int, int);
4179
4180
4181 /* Lisp window being scrolled. Set when starting to interact with
4182 a toolkit scroll bar, reset to nil when ending the interaction. */
4183
4184 static Lisp_Object window_being_scrolled;
4185
4186 /* Last scroll bar part sent in xm_scroll_callback. */
4187
4188 static int last_scroll_bar_part;
4189
4190 /* Whether this is an Xaw with arrow-scrollbars. This should imply
4191 that movements of 1/20 of the screen size are mapped to up/down. */
4192
4193 #ifndef USE_GTK
4194 /* Id of action hook installed for scroll bars. */
4195
4196 static XtActionHookId action_hook_id;
4197
4198 static Boolean xaw3d_arrow_scroll;
4199
4200 /* Whether the drag scrolling maintains the mouse at the top of the
4201 thumb. If not, resizing the thumb needs to be done more carefully
4202 to avoid jerkiness. */
4203
4204 static Boolean xaw3d_pick_top;
4205
4206 /* Action hook installed via XtAppAddActionHook when toolkit scroll
4207 bars are used.. The hook is responsible for detecting when
4208 the user ends an interaction with the scroll bar, and generates
4209 a `end-scroll' SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT' event if so. */
4210
4211 static void
4212 xt_action_hook (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, String action_name,
4213 XEvent *event, String *params, Cardinal *num_params)
4214 {
4215 int scroll_bar_p;
4216 const char *end_action;
4217
4218 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4219 scroll_bar_p = XmIsScrollBar (widget);
4220 end_action = "Release";
4221 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4222 scroll_bar_p = XtIsSubclass (widget, scrollbarWidgetClass);
4223 end_action = "EndScroll";
4224 #endif /* USE_MOTIF */
4225
4226 if (scroll_bar_p
4227 && strcmp (action_name, end_action) == 0
4228 && WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled))
4229 {
4230 struct window *w;
4231
4232 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled,
4233 scroll_bar_end_scroll, 0, 0);
4234 w = XWINDOW (window_being_scrolled);
4235
4236 if (!NILP (XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging))
4237 {
4238 XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar)->dragging = Qnil;
4239 /* The thumb size is incorrect while dragging: fix it. */
4240 set_vertical_scroll_bar (w);
4241 }
4242 window_being_scrolled = Qnil;
4243 last_scroll_bar_part = -1;
4244
4245 /* Xt timeouts no longer needed. */
4246 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 0;
4247 }
4248 }
4249 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4250
4251 /* A vector of windows used for communication between
4252 x_send_scroll_bar_event and x_scroll_bar_to_input_event. */
4253
4254 static struct window **scroll_bar_windows;
4255 static ptrdiff_t scroll_bar_windows_size;
4256
4257
4258 /* Send a client message with message type Xatom_Scrollbar for a
4259 scroll action to the frame of WINDOW. PART is a value identifying
4260 the part of the scroll bar that was clicked on. PORTION is the
4261 amount to scroll of a whole of WHOLE. */
4262
4263 static void
4264 x_send_scroll_bar_event (Lisp_Object window, int part, int portion, int whole)
4265 {
4266 XEvent event;
4267 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) &event;
4268 struct window *w = XWINDOW (window);
4269 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4270 ptrdiff_t i;
4271
4272 BLOCK_INPUT;
4273
4274 /* Construct a ClientMessage event to send to the frame. */
4275 ev->type = ClientMessage;
4276 ev->message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_Scrollbar;
4277 ev->display = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
4278 ev->window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
4279 ev->format = 32;
4280
4281 /* We can only transfer 32 bits in the XClientMessageEvent, which is
4282 not enough to store a pointer or Lisp_Object on a 64 bit system.
4283 So, store the window in scroll_bar_windows and pass the index
4284 into that array in the event. */
4285 for (i = 0; i < scroll_bar_windows_size; ++i)
4286 if (scroll_bar_windows[i] == NULL)
4287 break;
4288
4289 if (i == scroll_bar_windows_size)
4290 {
4291 ptrdiff_t old_nbytes =
4292 scroll_bar_windows_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4293 ptrdiff_t nbytes;
4294 enum { XClientMessageEvent_MAX = 0x7fffffff };
4295 scroll_bar_windows =
4296 xpalloc (scroll_bar_windows, &scroll_bar_windows_size, 1,
4297 XClientMessageEvent_MAX, sizeof *scroll_bar_windows);
4298 nbytes = scroll_bar_windows_size * sizeof *scroll_bar_windows;
4299 memset (&scroll_bar_windows[i], 0, nbytes - old_nbytes);
4300 }
4301
4302 scroll_bar_windows[i] = w;
4303 ev->data.l[0] = (long) i;
4304 ev->data.l[1] = (long) part;
4305 ev->data.l[2] = (long) 0;
4306 ev->data.l[3] = (long) portion;
4307 ev->data.l[4] = (long) whole;
4308
4309 /* Make Xt timeouts work while the scroll bar is active. */
4310 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
4311 toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction = 1;
4312 x_activate_timeout_atimer ();
4313 #endif
4314
4315 /* Setting the event mask to zero means that the message will
4316 be sent to the client that created the window, and if that
4317 window no longer exists, no event will be sent. */
4318 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), False, 0, &event);
4319 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4320 }
4321
4322
4323 /* Transform a scroll bar ClientMessage EVENT to an Emacs input event
4324 in *IEVENT. */
4325
4326 static void
4327 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (XEvent *event, struct input_event *ievent)
4328 {
4329 XClientMessageEvent *ev = (XClientMessageEvent *) event;
4330 Lisp_Object window;
4331 struct window *w;
4332
4333 w = scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]];
4334 scroll_bar_windows[ev->data.l[0]] = NULL;
4335
4336 XSETWINDOW (window, w);
4337
4338 ievent->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
4339 ievent->frame_or_window = window;
4340 ievent->arg = Qnil;
4341 #ifdef USE_GTK
4342 ievent->timestamp = CurrentTime;
4343 #else
4344 ievent->timestamp =
4345 XtLastTimestampProcessed (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (XFRAME (w->frame)));
4346 #endif
4347 ievent->part = ev->data.l[1];
4348 ievent->code = ev->data.l[2];
4349 ievent->x = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[3]);
4350 ievent->y = make_number ((int) ev->data.l[4]);
4351 ievent->modifiers = 0;
4352 }
4353
4354
4355 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4356
4357 /* Minimum and maximum values used for Motif scroll bars. */
4358
4359 #define XM_SB_MAX 10000000
4360
4361
4362 /* Scroll bar callback for Motif scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4363 bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure.
4364 CALL_DATA is a pointer to a XmScrollBarCallbackStruct. */
4365
4366 static void
4367 xm_scroll_callback (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data)
4368 {
4369 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4370 XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *cs = (XmScrollBarCallbackStruct *) call_data;
4371 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4372
4373 switch (cs->reason)
4374 {
4375 case XmCR_DECREMENT:
4376 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4377 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4378 break;
4379
4380 case XmCR_INCREMENT:
4381 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4382 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4383 break;
4384
4385 case XmCR_PAGE_DECREMENT:
4386 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4387 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4388 break;
4389
4390 case XmCR_PAGE_INCREMENT:
4391 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4392 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4393 break;
4394
4395 case XmCR_TO_TOP:
4396 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4397 part = scroll_bar_to_top;
4398 break;
4399
4400 case XmCR_TO_BOTTOM:
4401 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4402 part = scroll_bar_to_bottom;
4403 break;
4404
4405 case XmCR_DRAG:
4406 {
4407 int slider_size;
4408
4409 /* Get the slider size. */
4410 BLOCK_INPUT;
4411 XtVaGetValues (widget, XmNsliderSize, &slider_size, NULL);
4412 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4413
4414 whole = XM_SB_MAX - slider_size;
4415 portion = min (cs->value, whole);
4416 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4417 bar->dragging = make_number (cs->value);
4418 }
4419 break;
4420
4421 case XmCR_VALUE_CHANGED:
4422 break;
4423 };
4424
4425 if (part >= 0)
4426 {
4427 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4428 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4429 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4430 }
4431 }
4432
4433 #elif defined USE_GTK
4434
4435 /* Scroll bar callback for GTK scroll bars. WIDGET is the scroll
4436 bar widget. DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure. */
4437
4438 static gboolean
4439 xg_scroll_callback (GtkRange *range,
4440 GtkScrollType scroll,
4441 gdouble value,
4442 gpointer user_data)
4443 {
4444 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) user_data;
4445 gdouble position;
4446 int part = -1, whole = 0, portion = 0;
4447 GtkAdjustment *adj = GTK_ADJUSTMENT (gtk_range_get_adjustment (range));
4448 FRAME_PTR f = (FRAME_PTR) g_object_get_data (G_OBJECT (range), XG_FRAME_DATA);
4449
4450 if (xg_ignore_gtk_scrollbar) return FALSE;
4451 position = gtk_adjustment_get_value (adj);
4452
4453
4454 switch (scroll)
4455 {
4456 case GTK_SCROLL_JUMP:
4457 /* Buttons 1 2 or 3 must be grabbed. */
4458 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->grabbed != 0
4459 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->grabbed < (1 << 4))
4460 {
4461 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4462 whole = gtk_adjustment_get_upper (adj) -
4463 gtk_adjustment_get_page_size (adj);
4464 portion = min ((int)position, whole);
4465 bar->dragging = make_number ((int)portion);
4466 }
4467 break;
4468 case GTK_SCROLL_STEP_BACKWARD:
4469 part = scroll_bar_up_arrow;
4470 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4471 break;
4472 case GTK_SCROLL_STEP_FORWARD:
4473 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4474 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4475 break;
4476 case GTK_SCROLL_PAGE_BACKWARD:
4477 part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
4478 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4479 break;
4480 case GTK_SCROLL_PAGE_FORWARD:
4481 part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
4482 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4483 break;
4484 }
4485
4486 if (part >= 0)
4487 {
4488 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4489 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4490 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4491 }
4492
4493 return FALSE;
4494 }
4495
4496 /* Callback for button release. Sets dragging to Qnil when dragging is done. */
4497
4498 static gboolean
4499 xg_end_scroll_callback (GtkWidget *widget,
4500 GdkEventButton *event,
4501 gpointer user_data)
4502 {
4503 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) user_data;
4504 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4505 if (WINDOWP (window_being_scrolled))
4506 {
4507 x_send_scroll_bar_event (window_being_scrolled,
4508 scroll_bar_end_scroll, 0, 0);
4509 window_being_scrolled = Qnil;
4510 }
4511
4512 return FALSE;
4513 }
4514
4515
4516 #else /* not USE_GTK and not USE_MOTIF */
4517
4518 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked when the thumb is dragged.
4519 WIDGET is the scroll bar widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the
4520 scroll bar struct. CALL_DATA is a pointer to a float saying where
4521 the thumb is. */
4522
4523 static void
4524 xaw_jump_callback (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data)
4525 {
4526 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4527 float top = *(float *) call_data;
4528 float shown;
4529 int whole, portion, height;
4530 int part;
4531
4532 /* Get the size of the thumb, a value between 0 and 1. */
4533 BLOCK_INPUT;
4534 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNshown, &shown, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4535 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4536
4537 whole = 10000000;
4538 portion = shown < 1 ? top * whole : 0;
4539
4540 if (shown < 1 && (eabs (top + shown - 1) < 1.0f / height))
4541 /* Some derivatives of Xaw refuse to shrink the thumb when you reach
4542 the bottom, so we force the scrolling whenever we see that we're
4543 too close to the bottom (in x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb
4544 we try to ensure that we always stay two pixels away from the
4545 bottom). */
4546 part = scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4547 else
4548 part = scroll_bar_handle;
4549
4550 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4551 bar->dragging = make_number (portion);
4552 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4553 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, portion, whole);
4554 }
4555
4556
4557 /* Xaw scroll bar callback. Invoked for incremental scrolling.,
4558 i.e. line or page up or down. WIDGET is the Xaw scroll bar
4559 widget. CLIENT_DATA is a pointer to the scroll_bar structure for
4560 the scroll bar. CALL_DATA is an integer specifying the action that
4561 has taken place. Its magnitude is in the range 0..height of the
4562 scroll bar. Negative values mean scroll towards buffer start.
4563 Values < height of scroll bar mean line-wise movement. */
4564
4565 static void
4566 xaw_scroll_callback (Widget widget, XtPointer client_data, XtPointer call_data)
4567 {
4568 struct scroll_bar *bar = (struct scroll_bar *) client_data;
4569 /* The position really is stored cast to a pointer. */
4570 int position = (long) call_data;
4571 Dimension height;
4572 int part;
4573
4574 /* Get the height of the scroll bar. */
4575 BLOCK_INPUT;
4576 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
4577 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4578
4579 if (eabs (position) >= height)
4580 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_above_handle : scroll_bar_below_handle;
4581
4582 /* If Xaw3d was compiled with ARROW_SCROLLBAR,
4583 it maps line-movement to call_data = max(5, height/20). */
4584 else if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll && eabs (position) <= max (5, height / 20))
4585 part = (position < 0) ? scroll_bar_up_arrow : scroll_bar_down_arrow;
4586 else
4587 part = scroll_bar_move_ratio;
4588
4589 window_being_scrolled = bar->window;
4590 bar->dragging = Qnil;
4591 last_scroll_bar_part = part;
4592 x_send_scroll_bar_event (bar->window, part, position, height);
4593 }
4594
4595 #endif /* not USE_GTK and not USE_MOTIF */
4596
4597 #define SCROLL_BAR_NAME "verticalScrollBar"
4598
4599 /* Create the widget for scroll bar BAR on frame F. Record the widget
4600 and X window of the scroll bar in BAR. */
4601
4602 #ifdef USE_GTK
4603 static void
4604 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *f, struct scroll_bar *bar)
4605 {
4606 const char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4607
4608 BLOCK_INPUT;
4609 xg_create_scroll_bar (f, bar, G_CALLBACK (xg_scroll_callback),
4610 G_CALLBACK (xg_end_scroll_callback),
4611 scroll_bar_name);
4612 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4613 }
4614
4615 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4616
4617 static void
4618 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (struct frame *f, struct scroll_bar *bar)
4619 {
4620 Window xwindow;
4621 Widget widget;
4622 Arg av[20];
4623 int ac = 0;
4624 const char *scroll_bar_name = SCROLL_BAR_NAME;
4625 unsigned long pixel;
4626
4627 BLOCK_INPUT;
4628
4629 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4630 /* Set resources. Create the widget. */
4631 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4632 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNminimum, 0); ++ac;
4633 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNmaximum, XM_SB_MAX); ++ac;
4634 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNorientation, XmVERTICAL); ++ac;
4635 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNprocessingDirection, XmMAX_ON_BOTTOM), ++ac;
4636 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNincrement, 1); ++ac;
4637 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNpageIncrement, 1); ++ac;
4638
4639 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4640 if (pixel != -1)
4641 {
4642 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNforeground, pixel);
4643 ++ac;
4644 }
4645
4646 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4647 if (pixel != -1)
4648 {
4649 XtSetArg (av[ac], XmNbackground, pixel);
4650 ++ac;
4651 }
4652
4653 widget = XmCreateScrollBar (f->output_data.x->edit_widget,
4654 (char *) scroll_bar_name, av, ac);
4655
4656 /* Add one callback for everything that can happen. */
4657 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4658 (XtPointer) bar);
4659 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNdragCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4660 (XtPointer) bar);
4661 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNincrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4662 (XtPointer) bar);
4663 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageDecrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4664 (XtPointer) bar);
4665 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNpageIncrementCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4666 (XtPointer) bar);
4667 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoBottomCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4668 (XtPointer) bar);
4669 XtAddCallback (widget, XmNtoTopCallback, xm_scroll_callback,
4670 (XtPointer) bar);
4671
4672 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4673 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4674
4675 /* Set the cursor to an arrow. I didn't find a resource to do that.
4676 And I'm wondering why it hasn't an arrow cursor by default. */
4677 XDefineCursor (XtDisplay (widget), XtWindow (widget),
4678 f->output_data.x->nontext_cursor);
4679
4680 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4681
4682 /* Set resources. Create the widget. The background of the
4683 Xaw3d scroll bar widget is a little bit light for my taste.
4684 We don't alter it here to let users change it according
4685 to their taste with `emacs*verticalScrollBar.background: xxx'. */
4686 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNmappedWhenManaged, False); ++ac;
4687 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNorientation, XtorientVertical); ++ac;
4688 /* For smoother scrolling with Xaw3d -sm */
4689 /* XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNpickTop, True); ++ac; */
4690
4691 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel;
4692 if (pixel != -1)
4693 {
4694 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNforeground, pixel);
4695 ++ac;
4696 }
4697
4698 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4699 if (pixel != -1)
4700 {
4701 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbackground, pixel);
4702 ++ac;
4703 }
4704
4705 /* Top/bottom shadow colors. */
4706
4707 /* Allocate them, if necessary. */
4708 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1)
4709 {
4710 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4711 if (pixel != -1)
4712 {
4713 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
4714 FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4715 &pixel, 1.2, 0x8000))
4716 pixel = -1;
4717 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4718 }
4719 }
4720 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4721 {
4722 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4723 if (pixel != -1)
4724 {
4725 if (!x_alloc_lighter_color (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
4726 FRAME_X_COLORMAP (f),
4727 &pixel, 0.6, 0x4000))
4728 pixel = -1;
4729 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel = pixel;
4730 }
4731 }
4732
4733 #ifdef XtNbeNiceToColormap
4734 /* Tell the toolkit about them. */
4735 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel == -1
4736 || f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel == -1)
4737 /* We tried to allocate a color for the top/bottom shadow, and
4738 failed, so tell Xaw3d to use dithering instead. */
4739 /* But only if we have a small colormap. Xaw3d can allocate nice
4740 colors itself. */
4741 {
4742 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap,
4743 DefaultDepthOfScreen (FRAME_X_SCREEN (f)) < 16);
4744 ++ac;
4745 }
4746 else
4747 /* Tell what colors Xaw3d should use for the top/bottom shadow, to
4748 be more consistent with other emacs 3d colors, and since Xaw3d is
4749 not good at dealing with allocation failure. */
4750 {
4751 /* This tells Xaw3d to use real colors instead of dithering for
4752 the shadows. */
4753 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbeNiceToColormap, False);
4754 ++ac;
4755
4756 /* Specify the colors. */
4757 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel;
4758 if (pixel != -1)
4759 {
4760 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNtopShadowPixel, pixel);
4761 ++ac;
4762 }
4763 pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel;
4764 if (pixel != -1)
4765 {
4766 XtSetArg (av[ac], XtNbottomShadowPixel, pixel);
4767 ++ac;
4768 }
4769 }
4770 #endif
4771
4772 widget = XtCreateWidget (scroll_bar_name, scrollbarWidgetClass,
4773 f->output_data.x->edit_widget, av, ac);
4774
4775 {
4776 char const *initial = "";
4777 char const *val = initial;
4778 XtVaGetValues (widget, XtNscrollVCursor, (XtPointer) &val,
4779 #ifdef XtNarrowScrollbars
4780 XtNarrowScrollbars, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_arrow_scroll,
4781 #endif
4782 XtNpickTop, (XtPointer) &xaw3d_pick_top, NULL);
4783 if (xaw3d_arrow_scroll || val == initial)
4784 { /* ARROW_SCROLL */
4785 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = True;
4786 /* Isn't that just a personal preference ? --Stef */
4787 XtVaSetValues (widget, XtNcursorName, "top_left_arrow", NULL);
4788 }
4789 }
4790
4791 /* Define callbacks. */
4792 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNjumpProc, xaw_jump_callback, (XtPointer) bar);
4793 XtAddCallback (widget, XtNscrollProc, xaw_scroll_callback,
4794 (XtPointer) bar);
4795
4796 /* Realize the widget. Only after that is the X window created. */
4797 XtRealizeWidget (widget);
4798
4799 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4800
4801 /* Install an action hook that lets us detect when the user
4802 finishes interacting with a scroll bar. */
4803 if (action_hook_id == 0)
4804 action_hook_id = XtAppAddActionHook (Xt_app_con, xt_action_hook, 0);
4805
4806 /* Remember X window and widget in the scroll bar vector. */
4807 SET_SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (bar, widget);
4808 xwindow = XtWindow (widget);
4809 bar->x_window = xwindow;
4810
4811 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4812 }
4813 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4814
4815
4816 /* Set the thumb size and position of scroll bar BAR. We are currently
4817 displaying PORTION out of a whole WHOLE, and our position POSITION. */
4818
4819 #ifdef USE_GTK
4820 static void
4821 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *bar, int portion, int position, int whole)
4822 {
4823 xg_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
4824 }
4825
4826 #else /* not USE_GTK */
4827 static void
4828 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (struct scroll_bar *bar, int portion, int position,
4829 int whole)
4830 {
4831 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
4832 Widget widget = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
4833 float top, shown;
4834
4835 BLOCK_INPUT;
4836
4837 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
4838
4839 /* We use an estimate of 30 chars per line rather than the real
4840 `portion' value. This has the disadvantage that the thumb size
4841 is not very representative, but it makes our life a lot easier.
4842 Otherwise, we have to constantly adjust the thumb size, which
4843 we can't always do quickly enough: while dragging, the size of
4844 the thumb might prevent the user from dragging the thumb all the
4845 way to the end. but Motif and some versions of Xaw3d don't allow
4846 updating the thumb size while dragging. Also, even if we can update
4847 its size, the update will often happen too late.
4848 If you don't believe it, check out revision 1.650 of xterm.c to see
4849 what hoops we were going through and the still poor behavior we got. */
4850 portion = WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (bar->window)) * 30;
4851 /* When the thumb is at the bottom, position == whole.
4852 So we need to increase `whole' to make space for the thumb. */
4853 whole += portion;
4854
4855 if (whole <= 0)
4856 top = 0, shown = 1;
4857 else
4858 {
4859 top = (float) position / whole;
4860 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4861 }
4862
4863 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4864 {
4865 int size, value;
4866
4867 /* Slider size. Must be in the range [1 .. MAX - MIN] where MAX
4868 is the scroll bar's maximum and MIN is the scroll bar's minimum
4869 value. */
4870 size = shown * XM_SB_MAX;
4871 size = min (size, XM_SB_MAX);
4872 size = max (size, 1);
4873
4874 /* Position. Must be in the range [MIN .. MAX - SLIDER_SIZE]. */
4875 value = top * XM_SB_MAX;
4876 value = min (value, XM_SB_MAX - size);
4877
4878 XmScrollBarSetValues (widget, value, size, 0, 0, False);
4879 }
4880 #else /* !USE_MOTIF i.e. use Xaw */
4881
4882 if (whole == 0)
4883 top = 0, shown = 1;
4884 else
4885 {
4886 top = (float) position / whole;
4887 shown = (float) portion / whole;
4888 }
4889
4890 {
4891 float old_top, old_shown;
4892 Dimension height;
4893 XtVaGetValues (widget,
4894 XtNtopOfThumb, &old_top,
4895 XtNshown, &old_shown,
4896 XtNheight, &height,
4897 NULL);
4898
4899 /* Massage the top+shown values. */
4900 if (NILP (bar->dragging) || last_scroll_bar_part == scroll_bar_down_arrow)
4901 top = max (0, min (1, top));
4902 else
4903 top = old_top;
4904 /* Keep two pixels available for moving the thumb down. */
4905 shown = max (0, min (1 - top - (2.0f / height), shown));
4906
4907 /* If the call to XawScrollbarSetThumb below doesn't seem to work,
4908 check that your system's configuration file contains a define
4909 for `NARROWPROTO'. See s/freebsd.h for an example. */
4910 if (top != old_top || shown != old_shown)
4911 {
4912 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
4913 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4914 else
4915 {
4916 /* Try to make the scrolling a tad smoother. */
4917 if (!xaw3d_pick_top)
4918 shown = min (shown, old_shown);
4919
4920 XawScrollbarSetThumb (widget, top, shown);
4921 }
4922 }
4923 }
4924 #endif /* !USE_MOTIF */
4925
4926 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
4927 }
4928 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
4929
4930 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4931
4932
4933 \f
4934 /************************************************************************
4935 Scroll bars, general
4936 ************************************************************************/
4937
4938 /* Create a scroll bar and return the scroll bar vector for it. W is
4939 the Emacs window on which to create the scroll bar. TOP, LEFT,
4940 WIDTH and HEIGHT are the pixel coordinates and dimensions of the
4941 scroll bar. */
4942
4943 static struct scroll_bar *
4944 x_scroll_bar_create (struct window *w, int top, int left, int width, int height)
4945 {
4946 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
4947 struct scroll_bar *bar
4948 = ALLOCATE_PSEUDOVECTOR (struct scroll_bar, x_window, PVEC_OTHER);
4949 Lisp_Object barobj;
4950
4951 BLOCK_INPUT;
4952
4953 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
4954 x_create_toolkit_scroll_bar (f, bar);
4955 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4956 {
4957 XSetWindowAttributes a;
4958 unsigned long mask;
4959 Window window;
4960
4961 a.background_pixel = f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel;
4962 if (a.background_pixel == -1)
4963 a.background_pixel = FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f);
4964
4965 a.event_mask = (ButtonPressMask | ButtonReleaseMask
4966 | ButtonMotionMask | PointerMotionHintMask
4967 | ExposureMask);
4968 a.cursor = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor;
4969
4970 mask = (CWBackPixel | CWEventMask | CWCursor);
4971
4972 /* Clear the area of W that will serve as a scroll bar. This is
4973 for the case that a window has been split horizontally. In
4974 this case, no clear_frame is generated to reduce flickering. */
4975 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
4976 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4977 left, top, width,
4978 window_box_height (w), False);
4979
4980 window = XCreateWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
4981 /* Position and size of scroll bar. */
4982 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
4983 top,
4984 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
4985 height,
4986 /* Border width, depth, class, and visual. */
4987 0,
4988 CopyFromParent,
4989 CopyFromParent,
4990 CopyFromParent,
4991 /* Attributes. */
4992 mask, &a);
4993 bar->x_window = window;
4994 }
4995 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
4996
4997 XSETWINDOW (bar->window, w);
4998 bar->top = top;
4999 bar->left = left;
5000 bar->width = width;
5001 bar->height = height;
5002 bar->start = 0;
5003 bar->end = 0;
5004 bar->dragging = Qnil;
5005 bar->fringe_extended_p = 0;
5006
5007 /* Add bar to its frame's list of scroll bars. */
5008 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5009 bar->prev = Qnil;
5010 XSETVECTOR (barobj, bar);
5011 fset_scroll_bars (f, barobj);
5012 if (!NILP (bar->next))
5013 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
5014
5015 /* Map the window/widget. */
5016 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5017 {
5018 #ifdef USE_GTK
5019 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
5020 bar->x_window,
5021 top,
5022 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5023 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
5024 max (height, 1));
5025 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5026 Widget scroll_bar = SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar);
5027 XtConfigureWidget (scroll_bar,
5028 left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5029 top,
5030 width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
5031 max (height, 1), 0);
5032 XtMapWidget (scroll_bar);
5033 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5034 }
5035 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5036 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window);
5037 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5038
5039 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5040 return bar;
5041 }
5042
5043
5044 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5045
5046 /* Draw BAR's handle in the proper position.
5047
5048 If the handle is already drawn from START to END, don't bother
5049 redrawing it, unless REBUILD is non-zero; in that case, always
5050 redraw it. (REBUILD is handy for drawing the handle after expose
5051 events.)
5052
5053 Normally, we want to constrain the start and end of the handle to
5054 fit inside its rectangle, but if the user is dragging the scroll
5055 bar handle, we want to let them drag it down all the way, so that
5056 the bar's top is as far down as it goes; otherwise, there's no way
5057 to move to the very end of the buffer. */
5058
5059 static void
5060 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (struct scroll_bar *bar, int start, int end, int rebuild)
5061 {
5062 int dragging = ! NILP (bar->dragging);
5063 Window w = bar->x_window;
5064 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5065 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
5066
5067 /* If the display is already accurate, do nothing. */
5068 if (! rebuild
5069 && start == bar->start
5070 && end == bar->end)
5071 return;
5072
5073 BLOCK_INPUT;
5074
5075 {
5076 int inside_width = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_WIDTH (f, bar->width);
5077 int inside_height = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_INSIDE_HEIGHT (f, bar->height);
5078 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
5079
5080 /* Make sure the values are reasonable, and try to preserve
5081 the distance between start and end. */
5082 {
5083 int length = end - start;
5084
5085 if (start < 0)
5086 start = 0;
5087 else if (start > top_range)
5088 start = top_range;
5089 end = start + length;
5090
5091 if (end < start)
5092 end = start;
5093 else if (end > top_range && ! dragging)
5094 end = top_range;
5095 }
5096
5097 /* Store the adjusted setting in the scroll bar. */
5098 bar->start = start;
5099 bar->end = end;
5100
5101 /* Clip the end position, just for display. */
5102 if (end > top_range)
5103 end = top_range;
5104
5105 /* Draw bottom positions VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE pixels
5106 below top positions, to make sure the handle is always at least
5107 that many pixels tall. */
5108 end += VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE;
5109
5110 /* Draw the empty space above the handle. Note that we can't clear
5111 zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
5112 if (0 < start)
5113 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5114 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
5115 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
5116 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER,
5117 inside_width, start,
5118 False);
5119
5120 /* Change to proper foreground color if one is specified. */
5121 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5122 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5123 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
5124
5125 /* Draw the handle itself. */
5126 XFillRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
5127 /* x, y, width, height */
5128 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
5129 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + start,
5130 inside_width, end - start);
5131
5132 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
5133 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5134 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5135 FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
5136
5137 /* Draw the empty space below the handle. Note that we can't
5138 clear zero-height areas; that means "clear to end of window." */
5139 if (end < inside_height)
5140 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5141 /* x, y, width, height, and exposures. */
5142 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_LEFT_BORDER,
5143 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER + end,
5144 inside_width, inside_height - end,
5145 False);
5146
5147 }
5148
5149 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5150 }
5151
5152 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5153
5154 /* Destroy scroll bar BAR, and set its Emacs window's scroll bar to
5155 nil. */
5156
5157 static void
5158 x_scroll_bar_remove (struct scroll_bar *bar)
5159 {
5160 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5161 BLOCK_INPUT;
5162
5163 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5164 #ifdef USE_GTK
5165 xg_remove_scroll_bar (f, bar->x_window);
5166 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5167 XtDestroyWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar));
5168 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5169 #else
5170 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window);
5171 #endif
5172
5173 /* Dissociate this scroll bar from its window. */
5174 wset_vertical_scroll_bar (XWINDOW (bar->window), Qnil);
5175
5176 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5177 }
5178
5179
5180 /* Set the handle of the vertical scroll bar for WINDOW to indicate
5181 that we are displaying PORTION characters out of a total of WHOLE
5182 characters, starting at POSITION. If WINDOW has no scroll bar,
5183 create one. */
5184
5185 static void
5186 XTset_vertical_scroll_bar (struct window *w, int portion, int whole, int position)
5187 {
5188 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
5189 Lisp_Object barobj;
5190 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5191 int top, height, left, sb_left, width, sb_width;
5192 int window_y, window_height;
5193 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5194 int fringe_extended_p;
5195 #endif
5196
5197 /* Get window dimensions. */
5198 window_box (w, -1, 0, &window_y, 0, &window_height);
5199 top = window_y;
5200 width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
5201 height = window_height;
5202
5203 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar area. */
5204 left = WINDOW_SCROLL_BAR_AREA_X (w);
5205
5206 /* Compute the width of the scroll bar which might be less than
5207 the width of the area reserved for the scroll bar. */
5208 if (WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w) > 0)
5209 sb_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (w);
5210 else
5211 sb_width = width;
5212
5213 /* Compute the left edge of the scroll bar. */
5214 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5215 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
5216 sb_left = left + (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w) ? width - sb_width : 0);
5217 else
5218 sb_left = left + (WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w) ? 0 : width - sb_width);
5219 #else
5220 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_RIGHT (w))
5221 sb_left = left + width - sb_width;
5222 else
5223 sb_left = left;
5224 #endif
5225
5226 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5227 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
5228 fringe_extended_p = (WINDOW_LEFTMOST_P (w)
5229 && WINDOW_LEFT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w)
5230 && (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
5231 || WINDOW_LEFT_MARGIN_COLS (w) == 0));
5232 else
5233 fringe_extended_p = (WINDOW_RIGHTMOST_P (w)
5234 && WINDOW_RIGHT_FRINGE_WIDTH (w)
5235 && (WINDOW_HAS_FRINGES_OUTSIDE_MARGINS (w)
5236 || WINDOW_RIGHT_MARGIN_COLS (w) == 0));
5237 #endif
5238
5239 /* Does the scroll bar exist yet? */
5240 if (NILP (w->vertical_scroll_bar))
5241 {
5242 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5243 {
5244 BLOCK_INPUT;
5245 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5246 if (fringe_extended_p)
5247 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5248 sb_left, top, sb_width, height, False);
5249 else
5250 #endif
5251 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5252 left, top, width, height, False);
5253 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5254 }
5255
5256 bar = x_scroll_bar_create (w, top, sb_left, sb_width, height);
5257 }
5258 else
5259 {
5260 /* It may just need to be moved and resized. */
5261 unsigned int mask = 0;
5262
5263 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (w->vertical_scroll_bar);
5264
5265 BLOCK_INPUT;
5266
5267 if (sb_left != bar->left)
5268 mask |= CWX;
5269 if (top != bar->top)
5270 mask |= CWY;
5271 if (sb_width != bar->width)
5272 mask |= CWWidth;
5273 if (height != bar->height)
5274 mask |= CWHeight;
5275
5276 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5277
5278 /* Move/size the scroll bar widget. */
5279 if (mask || bar->fringe_extended_p != fringe_extended_p)
5280 {
5281 /* Since toolkit scroll bars are smaller than the space reserved
5282 for them on the frame, we have to clear "under" them. */
5283 if (width > 0 && height > 0)
5284 {
5285 if (fringe_extended_p)
5286 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5287 sb_left, top, sb_width, height, False);
5288 else
5289 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5290 left, top, width, height, False);
5291 }
5292 #ifdef USE_GTK
5293 xg_update_scrollbar_pos (f,
5294 bar->x_window,
5295 top,
5296 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5297 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM *2,
5298 max (height, 1));
5299 #else /* not USE_GTK */
5300 XtConfigureWidget (SCROLL_BAR_X_WIDGET (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar),
5301 sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5302 top,
5303 sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2,
5304 max (height, 1), 0);
5305 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
5306 }
5307 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5308
5309 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because of
5310 VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM. */
5311 if (VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM)
5312 {
5313 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5314 left, top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5315 height, False);
5316 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5317 left + width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5318 top, VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM,
5319 height, False);
5320 }
5321
5322 /* Clear areas not covered by the scroll bar because it's not as
5323 wide as the area reserved for it. This makes sure a
5324 previous mode line display is cleared after C-x 2 C-x 1, for
5325 example. */
5326 {
5327 int area_width = WINDOW_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (w) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
5328 int rest = area_width - sb_width;
5329 if (rest > 0 && height > 0)
5330 {
5331 if (WINDOW_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_ON_LEFT (w))
5332 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5333 left + area_width - rest, top,
5334 rest, height, False);
5335 else
5336 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
5337 left, top, rest, height, False);
5338 }
5339 }
5340
5341 /* Move/size the scroll bar window. */
5342 if (mask)
5343 {
5344 XWindowChanges wc;
5345
5346 wc.x = sb_left + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5347 wc.y = top;
5348 wc.width = sb_width - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM * 2;
5349 wc.height = height;
5350 XConfigureWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), bar->x_window,
5351 mask, &wc);
5352 }
5353
5354 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5355
5356 /* Remember new settings. */
5357 bar->left = sb_left;
5358 bar->top = top;
5359 bar->width = sb_width;
5360 bar->height = height;
5361
5362 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5363 }
5364
5365 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5366 bar->fringe_extended_p = fringe_extended_p;
5367
5368 x_set_toolkit_scroll_bar_thumb (bar, portion, position, whole);
5369 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5370 /* Set the scroll bar's current state, unless we're currently being
5371 dragged. */
5372 if (NILP (bar->dragging))
5373 {
5374 int top_range = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, height);
5375
5376 if (whole == 0)
5377 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, 0, top_range, 0);
5378 else
5379 {
5380 int start = ((double) position * top_range) / whole;
5381 int end = ((double) (position + portion) * top_range) / whole;
5382 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, start, end, 0);
5383 }
5384 }
5385 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5386
5387 XSETVECTOR (barobj, bar);
5388 wset_vertical_scroll_bar (w, barobj);
5389 }
5390
5391
5392 /* The following three hooks are used when we're doing a thorough
5393 redisplay of the frame. We don't explicitly know which scroll bars
5394 are going to be deleted, because keeping track of when windows go
5395 away is a real pain - "Can you say set-window-configuration, boys
5396 and girls?" Instead, we just assert at the beginning of redisplay
5397 that *all* scroll bars are to be removed, and then save a scroll bar
5398 from the fiery pit when we actually redisplay its window. */
5399
5400 /* Arrange for all scroll bars on FRAME to be removed at the next call
5401 to `*judge_scroll_bars_hook'. A scroll bar may be spared if
5402 `*redeem_scroll_bar_hook' is applied to its window before the judgment. */
5403
5404 static void
5405 XTcondemn_scroll_bars (FRAME_PTR frame)
5406 {
5407 /* Transfer all the scroll bars to FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS. */
5408 while (! NILP (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5409 {
5410 Lisp_Object bar;
5411 bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5412 fset_scroll_bars (frame, XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next);
5413 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame);
5414 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->prev = Qnil;
5415 if (! NILP (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame)))
5416 XSCROLL_BAR (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (frame))->prev = bar;
5417 fset_condemned_scroll_bars (frame, bar);
5418 }
5419 }
5420
5421
5422 /* Un-mark WINDOW's scroll bar for deletion in this judgment cycle.
5423 Note that WINDOW isn't necessarily condemned at all. */
5424
5425 static void
5426 XTredeem_scroll_bar (struct window *window)
5427 {
5428 struct scroll_bar *bar;
5429 struct frame *f;
5430 Lisp_Object barobj;
5431
5432 /* We can't redeem this window's scroll bar if it doesn't have one. */
5433 if (NILP (window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5434 emacs_abort ();
5435
5436 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (window->vertical_scroll_bar);
5437
5438 /* Unlink it from the condemned list. */
5439 f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (window));
5440 if (NILP (bar->prev))
5441 {
5442 /* If the prev pointer is nil, it must be the first in one of
5443 the lists. */
5444 if (EQ (FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f), window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5445 /* It's not condemned. Everything's fine. */
5446 return;
5447 else if (EQ (FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f),
5448 window->vertical_scroll_bar))
5449 fset_condemned_scroll_bars (f, bar->next);
5450 else
5451 /* If its prev pointer is nil, it must be at the front of
5452 one or the other! */
5453 emacs_abort ();
5454 }
5455 else
5456 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->prev)->next = bar->next;
5457
5458 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5459 XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev = bar->prev;
5460
5461 bar->next = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5462 bar->prev = Qnil;
5463 XSETVECTOR (barobj, bar);
5464 fset_scroll_bars (f, barobj);
5465 if (! NILP (bar->next))
5466 XSETVECTOR (XSCROLL_BAR (bar->next)->prev, bar);
5467 }
5468
5469 /* Remove all scroll bars on FRAME that haven't been saved since the
5470 last call to `*condemn_scroll_bars_hook'. */
5471
5472 static void
5473 XTjudge_scroll_bars (FRAME_PTR f)
5474 {
5475 Lisp_Object bar, next;
5476
5477 bar = FRAME_CONDEMNED_SCROLL_BARS (f);
5478
5479 /* Clear out the condemned list now so we won't try to process any
5480 more events on the hapless scroll bars. */
5481 fset_condemned_scroll_bars (f, Qnil);
5482
5483 for (; ! NILP (bar); bar = next)
5484 {
5485 struct scroll_bar *b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
5486
5487 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
5488
5489 next = b->next;
5490 b->next = b->prev = Qnil;
5491 }
5492
5493 /* Now there should be no references to the condemned scroll bars,
5494 and they should get garbage-collected. */
5495 }
5496
5497
5498 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5499 /* Handle an Expose or GraphicsExpose event on a scroll bar. This
5500 is a no-op when using toolkit scroll bars.
5501
5502 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5503 mark bits. */
5504
5505 static void
5506 x_scroll_bar_expose (struct scroll_bar *bar, XEvent *event)
5507 {
5508 Window w = bar->x_window;
5509 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5510 GC gc = f->output_data.x->normal_gc;
5511 int width_trim = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH_TRIM;
5512
5513 BLOCK_INPUT;
5514
5515 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, bar->start, bar->end, 1);
5516
5517 /* Switch to scroll bar foreground color. */
5518 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5519 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5520 f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
5521
5522 /* Draw a one-pixel border just inside the edges of the scroll bar. */
5523 XDrawRectangle (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w, gc,
5524
5525 /* x, y, width, height */
5526 0, 0,
5527 bar->width - 1 - width_trim - width_trim,
5528 bar->height - 1);
5529
5530 /* Restore the foreground color of the GC if we changed it above. */
5531 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
5532 XSetForeground (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc,
5533 FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
5534
5535 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5536
5537 }
5538 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5539
5540 /* Handle a mouse click on the scroll bar BAR. If *EMACS_EVENT's kind
5541 is set to something other than NO_EVENT, it is enqueued.
5542
5543 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5544 mark bits. */
5545
5546
5547 static void
5548 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (struct scroll_bar *bar, XEvent *event, struct input_event *emacs_event)
5549 {
5550 if (! WINDOWP (bar->window))
5551 emacs_abort ();
5552
5553 emacs_event->kind = SCROLL_BAR_CLICK_EVENT;
5554 emacs_event->code = event->xbutton.button - Button1;
5555 emacs_event->modifiers
5556 = (x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO
5557 (XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)))),
5558 event->xbutton.state)
5559 | (event->type == ButtonRelease
5560 ? up_modifier
5561 : down_modifier));
5562 emacs_event->frame_or_window = bar->window;
5563 emacs_event->arg = Qnil;
5564 emacs_event->timestamp = event->xbutton.time;
5565 {
5566 int top_range
5567 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
5568 int y = event->xbutton.y - VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5569
5570 if (y < 0) y = 0;
5571 if (y > top_range) y = top_range;
5572
5573 if (y < bar->start)
5574 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5575 else if (y < bar->end + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5576 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_handle;
5577 else
5578 emacs_event->part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5579
5580 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5581 /* If the user has released the handle, set it to its final position. */
5582 if (event->type == ButtonRelease
5583 && ! NILP (bar->dragging))
5584 {
5585 int new_start = y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5586 int new_end = new_start + bar->end - bar->start;
5587
5588 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5589 bar->dragging = Qnil;
5590 }
5591 #endif
5592
5593 XSETINT (emacs_event->x, y);
5594 XSETINT (emacs_event->y, top_range);
5595 }
5596 }
5597
5598 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5599
5600 /* Handle some mouse motion while someone is dragging the scroll bar.
5601
5602 This may be called from a signal handler, so we have to ignore GC
5603 mark bits. */
5604
5605 static void
5606 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (struct scroll_bar *bar, XEvent *event)
5607 {
5608 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)->frame);
5609
5610 last_mouse_movement_time = event->xmotion.time;
5611
5612 f->mouse_moved = 1;
5613 XSETVECTOR (last_mouse_scroll_bar, bar);
5614
5615 /* If we're dragging the bar, display it. */
5616 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5617 {
5618 /* Where should the handle be now? */
5619 int new_start = event->xmotion.y - XINT (bar->dragging);
5620
5621 if (new_start != bar->start)
5622 {
5623 int new_end = new_start + bar->end - bar->start;
5624
5625 x_scroll_bar_set_handle (bar, new_start, new_end, 0);
5626 }
5627 }
5628 }
5629
5630 #endif /* !USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5631
5632 /* Return information to the user about the current position of the mouse
5633 on the scroll bar. */
5634
5635 static void
5636 x_scroll_bar_report_motion (FRAME_PTR *fp, Lisp_Object *bar_window,
5637 enum scroll_bar_part *part, Lisp_Object *x,
5638 Lisp_Object *y, Time *timestamp)
5639 {
5640 struct scroll_bar *bar = XSCROLL_BAR (last_mouse_scroll_bar);
5641 Window w = bar->x_window;
5642 FRAME_PTR f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (bar->window)));
5643 int win_x, win_y;
5644 Window dummy_window;
5645 int dummy_coord;
5646 unsigned int dummy_mask;
5647
5648 BLOCK_INPUT;
5649
5650 /* Get the mouse's position relative to the scroll bar window, and
5651 report that. */
5652 if (! XQueryPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), w,
5653
5654 /* Root, child, root x and root y. */
5655 &dummy_window, &dummy_window,
5656 &dummy_coord, &dummy_coord,
5657
5658 /* Position relative to scroll bar. */
5659 &win_x, &win_y,
5660
5661 /* Mouse buttons and modifier keys. */
5662 &dummy_mask))
5663 ;
5664 else
5665 {
5666 int top_range
5667 = VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_RANGE (f, bar->height);
5668
5669 win_y -= VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_TOP_BORDER;
5670
5671 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5672 win_y -= XINT (bar->dragging);
5673
5674 if (win_y < 0)
5675 win_y = 0;
5676 if (win_y > top_range)
5677 win_y = top_range;
5678
5679 *fp = f;
5680 *bar_window = bar->window;
5681
5682 if (! NILP (bar->dragging))
5683 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5684 else if (win_y < bar->start)
5685 *part = scroll_bar_above_handle;
5686 else if (win_y < bar->end + VERTICAL_SCROLL_BAR_MIN_HANDLE)
5687 *part = scroll_bar_handle;
5688 else
5689 *part = scroll_bar_below_handle;
5690
5691 XSETINT (*x, win_y);
5692 XSETINT (*y, top_range);
5693
5694 f->mouse_moved = 0;
5695 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
5696 }
5697
5698 *timestamp = last_mouse_movement_time;
5699
5700 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5701 }
5702
5703
5704 /* The screen has been cleared so we may have changed foreground or
5705 background colors, and the scroll bars may need to be redrawn.
5706 Clear out the scroll bars, and ask for expose events, so we can
5707 redraw them. */
5708
5709 static void
5710 x_scroll_bar_clear (FRAME_PTR f)
5711 {
5712 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
5713 Lisp_Object bar;
5714
5715 /* We can have scroll bars even if this is 0,
5716 if we just turned off scroll bar mode.
5717 But in that case we should not clear them. */
5718 if (FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f))
5719 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); VECTORP (bar);
5720 bar = XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->next)
5721 XClearArea (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5722 XSCROLL_BAR (bar)->x_window,
5723 0, 0, 0, 0, True);
5724 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
5725 }
5726
5727 \f
5728 /* The main X event-reading loop - XTread_socket. */
5729
5730 /* This holds the state XLookupString needs to implement dead keys
5731 and other tricks known as "compose processing". _X Window System_
5732 says that a portable program can't use this, but Stephen Gildea assures
5733 me that letting the compiler initialize it to zeros will work okay.
5734
5735 This must be defined outside of XTread_socket, for the same reasons
5736 given for enter_timestamp, above. */
5737
5738 static XComposeStatus compose_status;
5739
5740 /* Record the last 100 characters stored
5741 to help debug the loss-of-chars-during-GC problem. */
5742
5743 static int temp_index;
5744 static short temp_buffer[100];
5745
5746 #define STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG(keysym) \
5747 if (temp_index == sizeof temp_buffer / sizeof (short)) \
5748 temp_index = 0; \
5749 temp_buffer[temp_index++] = (keysym)
5750
5751 /* Set this to nonzero to fake an "X I/O error"
5752 on a particular display. */
5753
5754 static struct x_display_info *XTread_socket_fake_io_error;
5755
5756 /* When we find no input here, we occasionally do a no-op command
5757 to verify that the X server is still running and we can still talk with it.
5758 We try all the open displays, one by one.
5759 This variable is used for cycling thru the displays. */
5760
5761 static struct x_display_info *next_noop_dpyinfo;
5762
5763 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT || defined USE_GTK
5764 #define SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT \
5765 do \
5766 { \
5767 if (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event == 0) \
5768 f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event = \
5769 xmalloc (sizeof (XEvent)); \
5770 *f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event = event; \
5771 inev.ie.kind = MENU_BAR_ACTIVATE_EVENT; \
5772 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f); \
5773 } \
5774 while (0)
5775 #endif
5776
5777 enum
5778 {
5779 X_EVENT_NORMAL,
5780 X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT,
5781 X_EVENT_DROP
5782 };
5783
5784 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5785 DPYINFO is the display this event is for.
5786 EVENT is the X event to filter.
5787
5788 Returns non-zero if the event was filtered, caller shall not process
5789 this event further.
5790 Returns zero if event is wasn't filtered. */
5791
5792 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5793 static int
5794 x_filter_event (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, XEvent *event)
5795 {
5796 /* XFilterEvent returns non-zero if the input method has
5797 consumed the event. We pass the frame's X window to
5798 XFilterEvent because that's the one for which the IC
5799 was created. */
5800
5801 struct frame *f1 = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5802 event->xclient.window);
5803
5804 return XFilterEvent (event, f1 ? FRAME_X_WINDOW (f1) : None);
5805 }
5806 #endif
5807
5808 #ifdef USE_GTK
5809 static int current_count;
5810 static int current_finish;
5811 static struct input_event *current_hold_quit;
5812
5813 /* This is the filter function invoked by the GTK event loop.
5814 It is invoked before the XEvent is translated to a GdkEvent,
5815 so we have a chance to act on the event before GTK. */
5816 static GdkFilterReturn
5817 event_handler_gdk (GdkXEvent *gxev, GdkEvent *ev, gpointer data)
5818 {
5819 XEvent *xev = (XEvent *) gxev;
5820
5821 BLOCK_INPUT;
5822 if (current_count >= 0)
5823 {
5824 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
5825
5826 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (xev->xany.display);
5827
5828 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5829 /* Filter events for the current X input method.
5830 GTK calls XFilterEvent but not for key press and release,
5831 so we do it here. */
5832 if ((xev->type == KeyPress || xev->type == KeyRelease)
5833 && dpyinfo
5834 && x_filter_event (dpyinfo, xev))
5835 {
5836 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5837 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5838 }
5839 #endif
5840
5841 if (! dpyinfo)
5842 current_finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
5843 else
5844 current_count +=
5845 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, xev, &current_finish,
5846 current_hold_quit);
5847 }
5848 else
5849 current_finish = x_dispatch_event (xev, xev->xany.display);
5850
5851 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
5852
5853 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT || current_finish == X_EVENT_DROP)
5854 return GDK_FILTER_REMOVE;
5855
5856 return GDK_FILTER_CONTINUE;
5857 }
5858 #endif /* USE_GTK */
5859
5860
5861 static void xembed_send_message (struct frame *f, Time,
5862 enum xembed_message,
5863 long detail, long data1, long data2);
5864
5865 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DPYINFO.
5866
5867 *FINISH is X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT if caller should stop reading events.
5868 *FINISH is zero if caller should continue reading events.
5869 *FINISH is X_EVENT_DROP if event should not be passed to the toolkit.
5870
5871 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer. */
5872
5873 static int
5874 handle_one_xevent (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, XEvent *eventptr,
5875 int *finish, struct input_event *hold_quit)
5876 {
5877 union {
5878 struct input_event ie;
5879 struct selection_input_event sie;
5880 } inev;
5881 int count = 0;
5882 int do_help = 0;
5883 ptrdiff_t nbytes = 0;
5884 struct frame *f = NULL;
5885 struct coding_system coding;
5886 XEvent event = *eventptr;
5887 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = &dpyinfo->mouse_highlight;
5888 USE_SAFE_ALLOCA;
5889
5890 *finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
5891
5892 EVENT_INIT (inev.ie);
5893 inev.ie.kind = NO_EVENT;
5894 inev.ie.arg = Qnil;
5895
5896 if (pending_event_wait.eventtype == event.type)
5897 pending_event_wait.eventtype = 0; /* Indicates we got it. */
5898
5899 switch (event.type)
5900 {
5901 case ClientMessage:
5902 {
5903 if (event.xclient.message_type
5904 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols
5905 && event.xclient.format == 32)
5906 {
5907 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5908 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus)
5909 {
5910 /* Use x_any_window_to_frame because this
5911 could be the shell widget window
5912 if the frame has no title bar. */
5913 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
5914 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
5915 /* Not quite sure this is needed -pd */
5916 if (f && FRAME_XIC (f))
5917 XSetICFocus (FRAME_XIC (f));
5918 #endif
5919 #if 0 /* Emacs sets WM hints whose `input' field is `true'. This
5920 instructs the WM to set the input focus automatically for
5921 Emacs with a call to XSetInputFocus. Setting WM_TAKE_FOCUS
5922 tells the WM to send us a ClientMessage WM_TAKE_FOCUS after
5923 it has set the focus. So, XSetInputFocus below is not
5924 needed.
5925
5926 The call to XSetInputFocus below has also caused trouble. In
5927 cases where the XSetInputFocus done by the WM and the one
5928 below are temporally close (on a fast machine), the call
5929 below can generate additional FocusIn events which confuse
5930 Emacs. */
5931
5932 /* Since we set WM_TAKE_FOCUS, we must call
5933 XSetInputFocus explicitly. But not if f is null,
5934 since that might be an event for a deleted frame. */
5935 if (f)
5936 {
5937 Display *d = event.xclient.display;
5938 /* Catch and ignore errors, in case window has been
5939 iconified by a window manager such as GWM. */
5940 x_catch_errors (d);
5941 XSetInputFocus (d, event.xclient.window,
5942 /* The ICCCM says this is
5943 the only valid choice. */
5944 RevertToParent,
5945 event.xclient.data.l[1]);
5946 /* This is needed to detect the error
5947 if there is an error. */
5948 XSync (d, False);
5949 x_uncatch_errors ();
5950 }
5951 /* Not certain about handling scroll bars here */
5952 #endif /* 0 */
5953 goto done;
5954 }
5955
5956 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5957 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself)
5958 {
5959 /* Save state modify the WM_COMMAND property to
5960 something which can reinstate us. This notifies
5961 the session manager, who's looking for such a
5962 PropertyNotify. Can restart processing when
5963 a keyboard or mouse event arrives. */
5964 /* If we have a session manager, don't set this.
5965 KDE will then start two Emacsen, one for the
5966 session manager and one for this. */
5967 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
5968 if (! x_session_have_connection ())
5969 #endif
5970 {
5971 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5972 event.xclient.window);
5973 /* This is just so we only give real data once
5974 for a single Emacs process. */
5975 if (f == SELECTED_FRAME ())
5976 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5977 event.xclient.window,
5978 initial_argv, initial_argc);
5979 else if (f)
5980 XSetCommand (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
5981 event.xclient.window,
5982 0, 0);
5983 }
5984 goto done;
5985 }
5986
5987 if (event.xclient.data.l[0]
5988 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window)
5989 {
5990 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo,
5991 event.xclient.window);
5992 if (!f)
5993 goto OTHER; /* May be a dialog that is to be removed */
5994
5995 inev.ie.kind = DELETE_WINDOW_EVENT;
5996 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
5997 goto done;
5998 }
5999
6000 goto done;
6001 }
6002
6003 if (event.xclient.message_type
6004 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied)
6005 {
6006 goto done;
6007 }
6008
6009 if (event.xclient.message_type
6010 == dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved)
6011 {
6012 int new_x, new_y;
6013 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
6014
6015 new_x = event.xclient.data.s[0];
6016 new_y = event.xclient.data.s[1];
6017
6018 if (f)
6019 {
6020 f->left_pos = new_x;
6021 f->top_pos = new_y;
6022 }
6023 goto done;
6024 }
6025
6026 #ifdef HACK_EDITRES
6027 if (event.xclient.message_type
6028 == dpyinfo->Xatom_editres)
6029 {
6030 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
6031 if (f)
6032 _XEditResCheckMessages (f->output_data.x->widget, NULL,
6033 &event, NULL);
6034 goto done;
6035 }
6036 #endif /* HACK_EDITRES */
6037
6038 if ((event.xclient.message_type
6039 == dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE)
6040 || (event.xclient.message_type
6041 == dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE))
6042 {
6043 /* Ghostview job completed. Kill it. We could
6044 reply with "Next" if we received "Page", but we
6045 currently never do because we are interested in
6046 images, only, which should have 1 page. */
6047 Pixmap pixmap = (Pixmap) event.xclient.data.l[1];
6048 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
6049 if (!f)
6050 goto OTHER;
6051 x_kill_gs_process (pixmap, f);
6052 expose_frame (f, 0, 0, 0, 0);
6053 goto done;
6054 }
6055
6056 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6057 /* Scroll bar callbacks send a ClientMessage from which
6058 we construct an input_event. */
6059 if (event.xclient.message_type
6060 == dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar)
6061 {
6062 x_scroll_bar_to_input_event (&event, &inev.ie);
6063 *finish = X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT;
6064 goto done;
6065 }
6066 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6067
6068 /* XEmbed messages from the embedder (if any). */
6069 if (event.xclient.message_type
6070 == dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED)
6071 {
6072 enum xembed_message msg = event.xclient.data.l[1];
6073 if (msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_IN || msg == XEMBED_FOCUS_OUT)
6074 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6075
6076 *finish = X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT;
6077 goto done;
6078 }
6079
6080 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, &event);
6081
6082 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xclient.window);
6083 if (!f)
6084 goto OTHER;
6085 if (x_handle_dnd_message (f, &event.xclient, dpyinfo, &inev.ie))
6086 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6087 }
6088 break;
6089
6090 case SelectionNotify:
6091 last_user_time = event.xselection.time;
6092 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6093 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselection.requestor))
6094 goto OTHER;
6095 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6096 x_handle_selection_notify (&event.xselection);
6097 break;
6098
6099 case SelectionClear: /* Someone has grabbed ownership. */
6100 last_user_time = event.xselectionclear.time;
6101 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6102 if (! x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionclear.window))
6103 goto OTHER;
6104 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6105 {
6106 XSelectionClearEvent *eventp = &(event.xselectionclear);
6107
6108 inev.ie.kind = SELECTION_CLEAR_EVENT;
6109 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev.sie) = eventp->display;
6110 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev.sie) = eventp->selection;
6111 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev.sie) = eventp->time;
6112 inev.ie.frame_or_window = Qnil;
6113 }
6114 break;
6115
6116 case SelectionRequest: /* Someone wants our selection. */
6117 last_user_time = event.xselectionrequest.time;
6118 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6119 if (!x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xselectionrequest.owner))
6120 goto OTHER;
6121 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6122 {
6123 XSelectionRequestEvent *eventp = &(event.xselectionrequest);
6124
6125 inev.ie.kind = SELECTION_REQUEST_EVENT;
6126 SELECTION_EVENT_DISPLAY (&inev.sie) = eventp->display;
6127 SELECTION_EVENT_REQUESTOR (&inev.sie) = eventp->requestor;
6128 SELECTION_EVENT_SELECTION (&inev.sie) = eventp->selection;
6129 SELECTION_EVENT_TARGET (&inev.sie) = eventp->target;
6130 SELECTION_EVENT_PROPERTY (&inev.sie) = eventp->property;
6131 SELECTION_EVENT_TIME (&inev.sie) = eventp->time;
6132 inev.ie.frame_or_window = Qnil;
6133 }
6134 break;
6135
6136 case PropertyNotify:
6137 last_user_time = event.xproperty.time;
6138 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xproperty.window);
6139 if (f && event.xproperty.atom == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state)
6140 if (x_handle_net_wm_state (f, &event.xproperty) && f->iconified
6141 && f->output_data.x->net_wm_state_hidden_seen)
6142 {
6143 /* Gnome shell does not iconify us when C-z is pressed. It hides
6144 the frame. So if our state says we aren't hidden anymore,
6145 treat it as deiconified. */
6146 if (! f->async_iconified)
6147 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6148 f->async_visible = 1;
6149 f->async_iconified = 0;
6150 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6151 f->output_data.x->net_wm_state_hidden_seen = 0;
6152 inev.ie.kind = DEICONIFY_EVENT;
6153 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6154 }
6155
6156 x_handle_property_notify (&event.xproperty);
6157 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, &event);
6158 goto OTHER;
6159
6160 case ReparentNotify:
6161 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xreparent.window);
6162 if (f)
6163 {
6164 int x, y;
6165 f->output_data.x->parent_desc = event.xreparent.parent;
6166 x_real_positions (f, &x, &y);
6167 f->left_pos = x;
6168 f->top_pos = y;
6169
6170 /* Perhaps reparented due to a WM restart. Reset this. */
6171 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
6172 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->net_supported_window = 0;
6173
6174 x_set_frame_alpha (f);
6175 }
6176 goto OTHER;
6177
6178 case Expose:
6179 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xexpose.window);
6180 if (f)
6181 {
6182 #ifdef USE_GTK
6183 /* This seems to be needed for GTK 2.6. */
6184 x_clear_area (event.xexpose.display,
6185 event.xexpose.window,
6186 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
6187 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height,
6188 FALSE);
6189 #endif
6190 if (f->async_visible == 0)
6191 {
6192 f->async_visible = 1;
6193 f->async_iconified = 0;
6194 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6195 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6196 }
6197 else
6198 expose_frame (f,
6199 event.xexpose.x, event.xexpose.y,
6200 event.xexpose.width, event.xexpose.height);
6201 }
6202 else
6203 {
6204 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6205 struct scroll_bar *bar;
6206 #endif
6207 #if defined USE_LUCID
6208 /* Submenus of the Lucid menu bar aren't widgets
6209 themselves, so there's no way to dispatch events
6210 to them. Recognize this case separately. */
6211 {
6212 Widget widget
6213 = x_window_to_menu_bar (event.xexpose.window);
6214 if (widget)
6215 xlwmenu_redisplay (widget);
6216 }
6217 #endif /* USE_LUCID */
6218
6219 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6220 /* Dispatch event to the widget. */
6221 goto OTHER;
6222 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6223 bar = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xexpose.display,
6224 event.xexpose.window);
6225
6226 if (bar)
6227 x_scroll_bar_expose (bar, &event);
6228 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6229 else
6230 goto OTHER;
6231 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6232 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6233 }
6234 break;
6235
6236 case GraphicsExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6237 source area was obscured or not
6238 available. */
6239 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xgraphicsexpose.drawable);
6240 if (f)
6241 {
6242 expose_frame (f,
6243 event.xgraphicsexpose.x, event.xgraphicsexpose.y,
6244 event.xgraphicsexpose.width,
6245 event.xgraphicsexpose.height);
6246 }
6247 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6248 else
6249 goto OTHER;
6250 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
6251 break;
6252
6253 case NoExpose: /* This occurs when an XCopyArea's
6254 source area was completely
6255 available. */
6256 break;
6257
6258 case UnmapNotify:
6259 /* Redo the mouse-highlight after the tooltip has gone. */
6260 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6261 {
6262 tip_window = 0;
6263 redo_mouse_highlight ();
6264 }
6265
6266 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xunmap.window);
6267 if (f) /* F may no longer exist if
6268 the frame was deleted. */
6269 {
6270 /* While a frame is unmapped, display generation is
6271 disabled; you don't want to spend time updating a
6272 display that won't ever be seen. */
6273 f->async_visible = 0;
6274 /* We can't distinguish, from the event, whether the window
6275 has become iconified or invisible. So assume, if it
6276 was previously visible, than now it is iconified.
6277 But x_make_frame_invisible clears both
6278 the visible flag and the iconified flag;
6279 and that way, we know the window is not iconified now. */
6280 if (FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) || FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f))
6281 {
6282 f->async_iconified = 1;
6283
6284 inev.ie.kind = ICONIFY_EVENT;
6285 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6286 }
6287 }
6288 goto OTHER;
6289
6290 case MapNotify:
6291 if (event.xmap.window == tip_window)
6292 /* The tooltip has been drawn already. Avoid
6293 the SET_FRAME_GARBAGED below. */
6294 goto OTHER;
6295
6296 /* We use x_top_window_to_frame because map events can
6297 come for sub-windows and they don't mean that the
6298 frame is visible. */
6299 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmap.window);
6300 if (f)
6301 {
6302 /* wait_reading_process_output will notice this and update
6303 the frame's display structures.
6304 If we where iconified, we should not set garbaged,
6305 because that stops redrawing on Expose events. This looks
6306 bad if we are called from a recursive event loop
6307 (x_dispatch_event), for example when a dialog is up. */
6308 if (! f->async_iconified)
6309 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6310
6311 /* Check if fullscreen was specified before we where mapped the
6312 first time, i.e. from the command line. */
6313 if (!f->output_data.x->has_been_visible)
6314 x_check_fullscreen (f);
6315
6316 f->async_visible = 1;
6317 f->async_iconified = 0;
6318 f->output_data.x->has_been_visible = 1;
6319
6320 if (f->iconified)
6321 {
6322 inev.ie.kind = DEICONIFY_EVENT;
6323 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6324 }
6325 else if (! NILP (Vframe_list)
6326 && ! NILP (XCDR (Vframe_list)))
6327 /* Force a redisplay sooner or later
6328 to update the frame titles
6329 in case this is the second frame. */
6330 record_asynch_buffer_change ();
6331
6332 #ifdef USE_GTK
6333 xg_frame_resized (f, -1, -1);
6334 #endif
6335 }
6336 goto OTHER;
6337
6338 case KeyPress:
6339
6340 last_user_time = event.xkey.time;
6341 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6342
6343 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6344 /* Dispatch KeyPress events when in menu. */
6345 if (popup_activated ())
6346 goto OTHER;
6347 #endif
6348
6349 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xkey.window);
6350
6351 /* If mouse-highlight is an integer, input clears out
6352 mouse highlighting. */
6353 if (!hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden && INTEGERP (Vmouse_highlight)
6354 && (f == 0
6355 || !EQ (f->tool_bar_window, hlinfo->mouse_face_window)))
6356 {
6357 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6358 hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 1;
6359 }
6360
6361 #if defined USE_MOTIF && defined USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6362 if (f == 0)
6363 {
6364 /* Scroll bars consume key events, but we want
6365 the keys to go to the scroll bar's frame. */
6366 Widget widget = XtWindowToWidget (dpyinfo->display,
6367 event.xkey.window);
6368 if (widget && XmIsScrollBar (widget))
6369 {
6370 widget = XtParent (widget);
6371 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, XtWindow (widget));
6372 }
6373 }
6374 #endif /* USE_MOTIF and USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6375
6376 if (f != 0)
6377 {
6378 KeySym keysym, orig_keysym;
6379 /* al%imercury@uunet.uu.net says that making this 81
6380 instead of 80 fixed a bug whereby meta chars made
6381 his Emacs hang.
6382
6383 It seems that some version of XmbLookupString has
6384 a bug of not returning XBufferOverflow in
6385 status_return even if the input is too long to
6386 fit in 81 bytes. So, we must prepare sufficient
6387 bytes for copy_buffer. 513 bytes (256 chars for
6388 two-byte character set) seems to be a fairly good
6389 approximation. -- 2000.8.10 handa@etl.go.jp */
6390 unsigned char copy_buffer[513];
6391 unsigned char *copy_bufptr = copy_buffer;
6392 int copy_bufsiz = sizeof (copy_buffer);
6393 int modifiers;
6394 Lisp_Object coding_system = Qlatin_1;
6395 Lisp_Object c;
6396
6397 #ifdef USE_GTK
6398 /* Don't pass keys to GTK. A Tab will shift focus to the
6399 tool bar in GTK 2.4. Keys will still go to menus and
6400 dialogs because in that case popup_activated is TRUE
6401 (see above). */
6402 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6403 #endif
6404
6405 event.xkey.state
6406 |= x_emacs_to_x_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f),
6407 extra_keyboard_modifiers);
6408 modifiers = event.xkey.state;
6409
6410 /* This will have to go some day... */
6411
6412 /* make_lispy_event turns chars into control chars.
6413 Don't do it here because XLookupString is too eager. */
6414 event.xkey.state &= ~ControlMask;
6415 event.xkey.state &= ~(dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask
6416 | dpyinfo->super_mod_mask
6417 | dpyinfo->hyper_mod_mask
6418 | dpyinfo->alt_mod_mask);
6419
6420 /* In case Meta is ComposeCharacter,
6421 clear its status. According to Markus Ehrnsperger
6422 Markus.Ehrnsperger@lehrstuhl-bross.physik.uni-muenchen.de
6423 this enables ComposeCharacter to work whether or
6424 not it is combined with Meta. */
6425 if (modifiers & dpyinfo->meta_mod_mask)
6426 memset (&compose_status, 0, sizeof (compose_status));
6427
6428 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6429 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
6430 {
6431 Status status_return;
6432
6433 coding_system = Vlocale_coding_system;
6434 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6435 &event.xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
6436 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6437 &status_return);
6438 if (status_return == XBufferOverflow)
6439 {
6440 copy_bufsiz = nbytes + 1;
6441 copy_bufptr = alloca (copy_bufsiz);
6442 nbytes = XmbLookupString (FRAME_XIC (f),
6443 &event.xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
6444 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6445 &status_return);
6446 }
6447 /* Xutf8LookupString is a new but already deprecated interface. -stef */
6448 if (status_return == XLookupNone)
6449 break;
6450 else if (status_return == XLookupChars)
6451 {
6452 keysym = NoSymbol;
6453 modifiers = 0;
6454 }
6455 else if (status_return != XLookupKeySym
6456 && status_return != XLookupBoth)
6457 emacs_abort ();
6458 }
6459 else
6460 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
6461 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6462 &compose_status);
6463 #else
6464 nbytes = XLookupString (&event.xkey, (char *) copy_bufptr,
6465 copy_bufsiz, &keysym,
6466 &compose_status);
6467 #endif
6468
6469 /* If not using XIM/XIC, and a compose sequence is in progress,
6470 we break here. Otherwise, chars_matched is always 0. */
6471 if (compose_status.chars_matched > 0 && nbytes == 0)
6472 break;
6473
6474 memset (&compose_status, 0, sizeof (compose_status));
6475 orig_keysym = keysym;
6476
6477 /* Common for all keysym input events. */
6478 XSETFRAME (inev.ie.frame_or_window, f);
6479 inev.ie.modifiers
6480 = x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f), modifiers);
6481 inev.ie.timestamp = event.xkey.time;
6482
6483 /* First deal with keysyms which have defined
6484 translations to characters. */
6485 if (keysym >= 32 && keysym < 128)
6486 /* Avoid explicitly decoding each ASCII character. */
6487 {
6488 inev.ie.kind = ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6489 inev.ie.code = keysym;
6490 goto done_keysym;
6491 }
6492
6493 /* Keysyms directly mapped to Unicode characters. */
6494 if (keysym >= 0x01000000 && keysym <= 0x0110FFFF)
6495 {
6496 if (keysym < 0x01000080)
6497 inev.ie.kind = ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6498 else
6499 inev.ie.kind = MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6500 inev.ie.code = keysym & 0xFFFFFF;
6501 goto done_keysym;
6502 }
6503
6504 /* Now non-ASCII. */
6505 if (HASH_TABLE_P (Vx_keysym_table)
6506 && (c = Fgethash (make_number (keysym),
6507 Vx_keysym_table,
6508 Qnil),
6509 NATNUMP (c)))
6510 {
6511 inev.ie.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (XFASTINT (c))
6512 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6513 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6514 inev.ie.code = XFASTINT (c);
6515 goto done_keysym;
6516 }
6517
6518 /* Random non-modifier sorts of keysyms. */
6519 if (((keysym >= XK_BackSpace && keysym <= XK_Escape)
6520 || keysym == XK_Delete
6521 #ifdef XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6522 || (keysym >= XK_ISO_Left_Tab
6523 && keysym <= XK_ISO_Enter)
6524 #endif
6525 || IsCursorKey (keysym) /* 0xff50 <= x < 0xff60 */
6526 || IsMiscFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xff60 <= x < VARIES */
6527 #ifdef HPUX
6528 /* This recognizes the "extended function
6529 keys". It seems there's no cleaner way.
6530 Test IsModifierKey to avoid handling
6531 mode_switch incorrectly. */
6532 || (XK_Select <= keysym && keysym < XK_KP_Space)
6533 #endif
6534 #ifdef XK_dead_circumflex
6535 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_circumflex
6536 #endif
6537 #ifdef XK_dead_grave
6538 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_grave
6539 #endif
6540 #ifdef XK_dead_tilde
6541 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_tilde
6542 #endif
6543 #ifdef XK_dead_diaeresis
6544 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_diaeresis
6545 #endif
6546 #ifdef XK_dead_macron
6547 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_macron
6548 #endif
6549 #ifdef XK_dead_degree
6550 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_degree
6551 #endif
6552 #ifdef XK_dead_acute
6553 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_acute
6554 #endif
6555 #ifdef XK_dead_cedilla
6556 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_cedilla
6557 #endif
6558 #ifdef XK_dead_breve
6559 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_breve
6560 #endif
6561 #ifdef XK_dead_ogonek
6562 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_ogonek
6563 #endif
6564 #ifdef XK_dead_caron
6565 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_caron
6566 #endif
6567 #ifdef XK_dead_doubleacute
6568 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_doubleacute
6569 #endif
6570 #ifdef XK_dead_abovedot
6571 || orig_keysym == XK_dead_abovedot
6572 #endif
6573 || IsKeypadKey (keysym) /* 0xff80 <= x < 0xffbe */
6574 || IsFunctionKey (keysym) /* 0xffbe <= x < 0xffe1 */
6575 /* Any "vendor-specific" key is ok. */
6576 || (orig_keysym & (1 << 28))
6577 || (keysym != NoSymbol && nbytes == 0))
6578 && ! (IsModifierKey (orig_keysym)
6579 /* The symbols from XK_ISO_Lock
6580 to XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6581 don't have real modifiers but
6582 should be treated similarly to
6583 Mode_switch by Emacs. */
6584 #if defined XK_ISO_Lock && defined XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock
6585 || (XK_ISO_Lock <= orig_keysym
6586 && orig_keysym <= XK_ISO_Last_Group_Lock)
6587 #endif
6588 ))
6589 {
6590 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (keysym);
6591 /* make_lispy_event will convert this to a symbolic
6592 key. */
6593 inev.ie.kind = NON_ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT;
6594 inev.ie.code = keysym;
6595 goto done_keysym;
6596 }
6597
6598 { /* Raw bytes, not keysym. */
6599 ptrdiff_t i;
6600 int nchars, len;
6601
6602 for (i = 0, nchars = 0; i < nbytes; i++)
6603 {
6604 if (ASCII_BYTE_P (copy_bufptr[i]))
6605 nchars++;
6606 STORE_KEYSYM_FOR_DEBUG (copy_bufptr[i]);
6607 }
6608
6609 if (nchars < nbytes)
6610 {
6611 /* Decode the input data. */
6612
6613 /* The input should be decoded with `coding_system'
6614 which depends on which X*LookupString function
6615 we used just above and the locale. */
6616 setup_coding_system (coding_system, &coding);
6617 coding.src_multibyte = 0;
6618 coding.dst_multibyte = 1;
6619 /* The input is converted to events, thus we can't
6620 handle composition. Anyway, there's no XIM that
6621 gives us composition information. */
6622 coding.common_flags &= ~CODING_ANNOTATION_MASK;
6623
6624 SAFE_NALLOCA (coding.destination, MAX_MULTIBYTE_LENGTH,
6625 nbytes);
6626 coding.dst_bytes = MAX_MULTIBYTE_LENGTH * nbytes;
6627 coding.mode |= CODING_MODE_LAST_BLOCK;
6628 decode_coding_c_string (&coding, copy_bufptr, nbytes, Qnil);
6629 nbytes = coding.produced;
6630 nchars = coding.produced_char;
6631 copy_bufptr = coding.destination;
6632 }
6633
6634 /* Convert the input data to a sequence of
6635 character events. */
6636 for (i = 0; i < nbytes; i += len)
6637 {
6638 int ch;
6639 if (nchars == nbytes)
6640 ch = copy_bufptr[i], len = 1;
6641 else
6642 ch = STRING_CHAR_AND_LENGTH (copy_bufptr + i, len);
6643 inev.ie.kind = (SINGLE_BYTE_CHAR_P (ch)
6644 ? ASCII_KEYSTROKE_EVENT
6645 : MULTIBYTE_CHAR_KEYSTROKE_EVENT);
6646 inev.ie.code = ch;
6647 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev.ie, hold_quit);
6648 }
6649
6650 count += nchars;
6651
6652 inev.ie.kind = NO_EVENT; /* Already stored above. */
6653
6654 if (keysym == NoSymbol)
6655 break;
6656 }
6657 }
6658 done_keysym:
6659 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6660 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6661 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6662 client. */
6663 break;
6664 #else
6665 goto OTHER;
6666 #endif
6667
6668 case KeyRelease:
6669 last_user_time = event.xkey.time;
6670 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6671 /* Don't dispatch this event since XtDispatchEvent calls
6672 XFilterEvent, and two calls in a row may freeze the
6673 client. */
6674 break;
6675 #else
6676 goto OTHER;
6677 #endif
6678
6679 case EnterNotify:
6680 last_user_time = event.xcrossing.time;
6681 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6682
6683 f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6684
6685 if (f && x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position)
6686 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = event.xmotion.time + 200;
6687
6688 /* EnterNotify counts as mouse movement,
6689 so update things that depend on mouse position. */
6690 if (f && !f->output_data.x->hourglass_p)
6691 note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion);
6692 #ifdef USE_GTK
6693 /* We may get an EnterNotify on the buttons in the toolbar. In that
6694 case we moved out of any highlighted area and need to note this. */
6695 if (!f && last_mouse_glyph_frame)
6696 note_mouse_movement (last_mouse_glyph_frame, &event.xmotion);
6697 #endif
6698 goto OTHER;
6699
6700 case FocusIn:
6701 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6702 goto OTHER;
6703
6704 case LeaveNotify:
6705 last_user_time = event.xcrossing.time;
6706 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6707
6708 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xcrossing.window);
6709 if (f)
6710 {
6711 if (f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
6712 {
6713 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6714 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6715 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6716 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
6717 }
6718
6719 /* Generate a nil HELP_EVENT to cancel a help-echo.
6720 Do it only if there's something to cancel.
6721 Otherwise, the startup message is cleared when
6722 the mouse leaves the frame. */
6723 if (any_help_event_p)
6724 do_help = -1;
6725 }
6726 #ifdef USE_GTK
6727 /* See comment in EnterNotify above */
6728 else if (last_mouse_glyph_frame)
6729 note_mouse_movement (last_mouse_glyph_frame, &event.xmotion);
6730 #endif
6731 goto OTHER;
6732
6733 case FocusOut:
6734 x_detect_focus_change (dpyinfo, &event, &inev.ie);
6735 goto OTHER;
6736
6737 case MotionNotify:
6738 {
6739 last_user_time = event.xmotion.time;
6740 previous_help_echo_string = help_echo_string;
6741 help_echo_string = Qnil;
6742
6743 if (dpyinfo->grabbed && last_mouse_frame
6744 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6745 f = last_mouse_frame;
6746 else
6747 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xmotion.window);
6748
6749 if (hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden)
6750 {
6751 hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
6752 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6753 }
6754
6755 #ifdef USE_GTK
6756 if (f && xg_event_is_for_scrollbar (f, &event))
6757 f = 0;
6758 #endif
6759 if (f)
6760 {
6761
6762 /* Generate SELECT_WINDOW_EVENTs when needed.
6763 Don't let popup menus influence things (bug#1261). */
6764 if (!NILP (Vmouse_autoselect_window) && !popup_activated ())
6765 {
6766 Lisp_Object window;
6767
6768 window = window_from_coordinates (f,
6769 event.xmotion.x, event.xmotion.y,
6770 0, 0);
6771
6772 /* Window will be selected only when it is not selected now and
6773 last mouse movement event was not in it. Minibuffer window
6774 will be selected only when it is active. */
6775 if (WINDOWP (window)
6776 && !EQ (window, last_window)
6777 && !EQ (window, selected_window)
6778 /* For click-to-focus window managers
6779 create event iff we don't leave the
6780 selected frame. */
6781 && (focus_follows_mouse
6782 || (EQ (XWINDOW (window)->frame,
6783 XWINDOW (selected_window)->frame))))
6784 {
6785 inev.ie.kind = SELECT_WINDOW_EVENT;
6786 inev.ie.frame_or_window = window;
6787 }
6788
6789 last_window=window;
6790 }
6791 if (!note_mouse_movement (f, &event.xmotion))
6792 help_echo_string = previous_help_echo_string;
6793 }
6794 else
6795 {
6796 #ifndef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6797 struct scroll_bar *bar
6798 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xmotion.display,
6799 event.xmotion.window);
6800
6801 if (bar)
6802 x_scroll_bar_note_movement (bar, &event);
6803 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6804
6805 /* If we move outside the frame, then we're
6806 certainly no longer on any text in the frame. */
6807 clear_mouse_face (hlinfo);
6808 }
6809
6810 /* If the contents of the global variable help_echo_string
6811 has changed, generate a HELP_EVENT. */
6812 if (!NILP (help_echo_string)
6813 || !NILP (previous_help_echo_string))
6814 do_help = 1;
6815 goto OTHER;
6816 }
6817
6818 case ConfigureNotify:
6819 f = x_top_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xconfigure.window);
6820 #ifdef USE_GTK
6821 if (!f
6822 && (f = x_any_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xconfigure.window))
6823 && event.xconfigure.window == FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
6824 {
6825 xg_frame_resized (f, event.xconfigure.width,
6826 event.xconfigure.height);
6827 f = 0;
6828 }
6829 #endif
6830 if (f)
6831 {
6832 #ifndef USE_X_TOOLKIT
6833 #ifndef USE_GTK
6834 int rows = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT_TO_TEXT_LINES (f, event.xconfigure.height);
6835 int columns = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS (f, event.xconfigure.width);
6836
6837 /* In the toolkit version, change_frame_size
6838 is called by the code that handles resizing
6839 of the EmacsFrame widget. */
6840
6841 /* Even if the number of character rows and columns has
6842 not changed, the font size may have changed, so we need
6843 to check the pixel dimensions as well. */
6844 if (columns != FRAME_COLS (f)
6845 || rows != FRAME_LINES (f)
6846 || event.xconfigure.width != FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
6847 || event.xconfigure.height != FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f))
6848 {
6849 change_frame_size (f, rows, columns, 0, 1, 0);
6850 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
6851 cancel_mouse_face (f);
6852 }
6853
6854 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = event.xconfigure.width;
6855 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = event.xconfigure.height;
6856 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
6857 #endif
6858
6859 #ifdef USE_GTK
6860 /* GTK creates windows but doesn't map them.
6861 Only get real positions when mapped. */
6862 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)
6863 && gtk_widget_get_mapped (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)))
6864 #endif
6865 {
6866 x_real_positions (f, &f->left_pos, &f->top_pos);
6867 }
6868
6869 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
6870 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea))
6871 xic_set_statusarea (f);
6872 #endif
6873
6874 }
6875 goto OTHER;
6876
6877 case ButtonRelease:
6878 case ButtonPress:
6879 {
6880 /* If we decide we want to generate an event to be seen
6881 by the rest of Emacs, we put it here. */
6882 int tool_bar_p = 0;
6883
6884 memset (&compose_status, 0, sizeof (compose_status));
6885 last_mouse_glyph_frame = 0;
6886 last_user_time = event.xbutton.time;
6887
6888 if (dpyinfo->grabbed
6889 && last_mouse_frame
6890 && FRAME_LIVE_P (last_mouse_frame))
6891 f = last_mouse_frame;
6892 else
6893 f = x_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, event.xbutton.window);
6894
6895 #ifdef USE_GTK
6896 if (f && xg_event_is_for_scrollbar (f, &event))
6897 f = 0;
6898 #endif
6899 if (f)
6900 {
6901 /* Is this in the tool-bar? */
6902 if (WINDOWP (f->tool_bar_window)
6903 && WINDOW_TOTAL_LINES (XWINDOW (f->tool_bar_window)))
6904 {
6905 Lisp_Object window;
6906 int x = event.xbutton.x;
6907 int y = event.xbutton.y;
6908
6909 window = window_from_coordinates (f, x, y, 0, 1);
6910 tool_bar_p = EQ (window, f->tool_bar_window);
6911
6912 if (tool_bar_p && event.xbutton.button < 4)
6913 {
6914 handle_tool_bar_click (f, x, y,
6915 event.xbutton.type == ButtonPress,
6916 x_x_to_emacs_modifiers (dpyinfo,
6917 event.xbutton.state));
6918 }
6919 }
6920
6921 if (!tool_bar_p)
6922 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6923 if (! popup_activated ())
6924 #endif
6925 {
6926 if (ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout)
6927 {
6928 if (event.type == ButtonPress
6929 && (int)(event.xbutton.time - ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout) > 0)
6930 {
6931 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6932 construct_mouse_click (&inev.ie, &event.xbutton, f);
6933 }
6934 if (event.type == ButtonRelease)
6935 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
6936 }
6937 else
6938 construct_mouse_click (&inev.ie, &event.xbutton, f);
6939 }
6940 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
6941 xembed_send_message (f, event.xbutton.time,
6942 XEMBED_REQUEST_FOCUS, 0, 0, 0);
6943 }
6944 else
6945 {
6946 struct scroll_bar *bar
6947 = x_window_to_scroll_bar (event.xbutton.display,
6948 event.xbutton.window);
6949
6950 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
6951 /* Make the "Ctrl-Mouse-2 splits window" work for toolkit
6952 scroll bars. */
6953 if (bar && event.xbutton.state & ControlMask)
6954 {
6955 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &inev.ie);
6956 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
6957 }
6958 #else /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6959 if (bar)
6960 x_scroll_bar_handle_click (bar, &event, &inev.ie);
6961 #endif /* not USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
6962 }
6963
6964 if (event.type == ButtonPress)
6965 {
6966 dpyinfo->grabbed |= (1 << event.xbutton.button);
6967 last_mouse_frame = f;
6968
6969 if (!tool_bar_p)
6970 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
6971 }
6972 else
6973 dpyinfo->grabbed &= ~(1 << event.xbutton.button);
6974
6975 /* Ignore any mouse motion that happened before this event;
6976 any subsequent mouse-movement Emacs events should reflect
6977 only motion after the ButtonPress/Release. */
6978 if (f != 0)
6979 f->mouse_moved = 0;
6980
6981 #if defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) || defined (USE_GTK)
6982 f = x_menubar_window_to_frame (dpyinfo, &event);
6983 /* For a down-event in the menu bar,
6984 don't pass it to Xt right now.
6985 Instead, save it away
6986 and we will pass it to Xt from kbd_buffer_get_event.
6987 That way, we can run some Lisp code first. */
6988 if (! popup_activated ()
6989 #ifdef USE_GTK
6990 /* Gtk+ menus only react to the first three buttons. */
6991 && event.xbutton.button < 3
6992 #endif
6993 && f && event.type == ButtonPress
6994 /* Verify the event is really within the menu bar
6995 and not just sent to it due to grabbing. */
6996 && event.xbutton.x >= 0
6997 && event.xbutton.x < FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)
6998 && event.xbutton.y >= 0
6999 && event.xbutton.y < f->output_data.x->menubar_height
7000 && event.xbutton.same_screen)
7001 {
7002 SET_SAVED_BUTTON_EVENT;
7003 XSETFRAME (last_mouse_press_frame, f);
7004 *finish = X_EVENT_DROP;
7005 }
7006 else if (event.type == ButtonPress)
7007 {
7008 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
7009 goto OTHER;
7010 }
7011 else
7012 goto OTHER;
7013 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT || USE_GTK */
7014 }
7015 break;
7016
7017 case CirculateNotify:
7018 goto OTHER;
7019
7020 case CirculateRequest:
7021 goto OTHER;
7022
7023 case VisibilityNotify:
7024 goto OTHER;
7025
7026 case MappingNotify:
7027 /* Someone has changed the keyboard mapping - update the
7028 local cache. */
7029 switch (event.xmapping.request)
7030 {
7031 case MappingModifier:
7032 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
7033 /* This is meant to fall through. */
7034 case MappingKeyboard:
7035 XRefreshKeyboardMapping (&event.xmapping);
7036 }
7037 goto OTHER;
7038
7039 case DestroyNotify:
7040 xft_settings_event (dpyinfo, &event);
7041 break;
7042
7043 default:
7044 OTHER:
7045 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
7046 BLOCK_INPUT;
7047 if (*finish != X_EVENT_DROP)
7048 XtDispatchEvent (&event);
7049 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7050 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
7051 break;
7052 }
7053
7054 done:
7055 if (inev.ie.kind != NO_EVENT)
7056 {
7057 kbd_buffer_store_event_hold (&inev.ie, hold_quit);
7058 count++;
7059 }
7060
7061 if (do_help
7062 && !(hold_quit && hold_quit->kind != NO_EVENT))
7063 {
7064 Lisp_Object frame;
7065
7066 if (f)
7067 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
7068 else
7069 frame = Qnil;
7070
7071 if (do_help > 0)
7072 {
7073 any_help_event_p = 1;
7074 gen_help_event (help_echo_string, frame, help_echo_window,
7075 help_echo_object, help_echo_pos);
7076 }
7077 else
7078 {
7079 help_echo_string = Qnil;
7080 gen_help_event (Qnil, frame, Qnil, Qnil, 0);
7081 }
7082 count++;
7083 }
7084
7085 SAFE_FREE ();
7086 *eventptr = event;
7087 return count;
7088 }
7089
7090 #if defined USE_GTK || defined USE_X_TOOLKIT
7091
7092 /* Handles the XEvent EVENT on display DISPLAY.
7093 This is used for event loops outside the normal event handling,
7094 i.e. looping while a popup menu or a dialog is posted.
7095
7096 Returns the value handle_one_xevent sets in the finish argument. */
7097 int
7098 x_dispatch_event (XEvent *event, Display *display)
7099 {
7100 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
7101 int finish = X_EVENT_NORMAL;
7102
7103 dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (display);
7104
7105 if (dpyinfo)
7106 handle_one_xevent (dpyinfo, event, &finish, 0);
7107
7108 return finish;
7109 }
7110 #endif
7111
7112
7113 /* Read events coming from the X server.
7114 This routine is called by the SIGIO handler only if SYNC_INPUT is
7115 not defined.
7116 We return as soon as there are no more events to be read.
7117
7118 We return the number of characters stored into the buffer,
7119 thus pretending to be `read' (except the characters we store
7120 in the keyboard buffer can be multibyte, so are not necessarily
7121 C chars).
7122
7123 EXPECTED is nonzero if the caller knows input is available. */
7124
7125 static int
7126 XTread_socket (struct terminal *terminal, int expected, struct input_event *hold_quit)
7127 {
7128 int count = 0;
7129 int event_found = 0;
7130
7131 if (interrupt_input_blocked)
7132 {
7133 interrupt_input_pending = 1;
7134 #ifdef SYNC_INPUT
7135 pending_signals = 1;
7136 #endif
7137 return -1;
7138 }
7139
7140 interrupt_input_pending = 0;
7141 #ifdef SYNC_INPUT
7142 pending_signals = pending_atimers;
7143 #endif
7144 BLOCK_INPUT;
7145
7146 /* So people can tell when we have read the available input. */
7147 input_signal_count++;
7148
7149 #ifndef SYNC_INPUT
7150 ++handling_signal;
7151 #endif
7152
7153 /* For debugging, this gives a way to fake an I/O error. */
7154 if (terminal->display_info.x == XTread_socket_fake_io_error)
7155 {
7156 XTread_socket_fake_io_error = 0;
7157 x_io_error_quitter (terminal->display_info.x->display);
7158 }
7159
7160 #ifndef USE_GTK
7161 while (XPending (terminal->display_info.x->display))
7162 {
7163 int finish;
7164 XEvent event;
7165
7166 XNextEvent (terminal->display_info.x->display, &event);
7167
7168 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7169 /* Filter events for the current X input method. */
7170 if (x_filter_event (terminal->display_info.x, &event))
7171 continue;
7172 #endif
7173 event_found = 1;
7174
7175 count += handle_one_xevent (terminal->display_info.x,
7176 &event, &finish, hold_quit);
7177
7178 if (finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7179 goto out;
7180 }
7181
7182 out:;
7183
7184 #else /* USE_GTK */
7185
7186 /* For GTK we must use the GTK event loop. But XEvents gets passed
7187 to our filter function above, and then to the big event switch.
7188 We use a bunch of globals to communicate with our filter function,
7189 that is kind of ugly, but it works.
7190
7191 There is no way to do one display at the time, GTK just does events
7192 from all displays. */
7193
7194 while (gtk_events_pending ())
7195 {
7196 current_count = count;
7197 current_hold_quit = hold_quit;
7198
7199 gtk_main_iteration ();
7200
7201 count = current_count;
7202 current_count = -1;
7203 current_hold_quit = 0;
7204
7205 if (current_finish == X_EVENT_GOTO_OUT)
7206 break;
7207 }
7208 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7209
7210 /* On some systems, an X bug causes Emacs to get no more events
7211 when the window is destroyed. Detect that. (1994.) */
7212 if (! event_found)
7213 {
7214 /* Emacs and the X Server eats up CPU time if XNoOp is done every time.
7215 One XNOOP in 100 loops will make Emacs terminate.
7216 B. Bretthauer, 1994 */
7217 x_noop_count++;
7218 if (x_noop_count >= 100)
7219 {
7220 x_noop_count=0;
7221
7222 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == 0)
7223 next_noop_dpyinfo = x_display_list;
7224
7225 XNoOp (next_noop_dpyinfo->display);
7226
7227 /* Each time we get here, cycle through the displays now open. */
7228 next_noop_dpyinfo = next_noop_dpyinfo->next;
7229 }
7230 }
7231
7232 /* If the focus was just given to an auto-raising frame,
7233 raise it now. */
7234 /* ??? This ought to be able to handle more than one such frame. */
7235 if (pending_autoraise_frame)
7236 {
7237 x_raise_frame (pending_autoraise_frame);
7238 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
7239 }
7240
7241 #ifndef SYNC_INPUT
7242 --handling_signal;
7243 #endif
7244 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7245
7246 return count;
7247 }
7248
7249
7250
7251 \f
7252 /***********************************************************************
7253 Text Cursor
7254 ***********************************************************************/
7255
7256 /* Set clipping for output in glyph row ROW. W is the window in which
7257 we operate. GC is the graphics context to set clipping in.
7258
7259 ROW may be a text row or, e.g., a mode line. Text rows must be
7260 clipped to the interior of the window dedicated to text display,
7261 mode lines must be clipped to the whole window. */
7262
7263 static void
7264 x_clip_to_row (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, int area, GC gc)
7265 {
7266 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7267 XRectangle clip_rect;
7268 int window_x, window_y, window_width;
7269
7270 window_box (w, area, &window_x, &window_y, &window_width, 0);
7271
7272 clip_rect.x = window_x;
7273 clip_rect.y = WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, max (0, row->y));
7274 clip_rect.y = max (clip_rect.y, window_y);
7275 clip_rect.width = window_width;
7276 clip_rect.height = row->visible_height;
7277
7278 XSetClipRectangles (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), gc, 0, 0, &clip_rect, 1, Unsorted);
7279 }
7280
7281
7282 /* Draw a hollow box cursor on window W in glyph row ROW. */
7283
7284 static void
7285 x_draw_hollow_cursor (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row)
7286 {
7287 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7288 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
7289 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7290 int x, y, wd, h;
7291 XGCValues xgcv;
7292 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7293 GC gc;
7294
7295 /* Get the glyph the cursor is on. If we can't tell because
7296 the current matrix is invalid or such, give up. */
7297 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7298 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7299 return;
7300
7301 /* Compute frame-relative coordinates for phys cursor. */
7302 get_phys_cursor_geometry (w, row, cursor_glyph, &x, &y, &h);
7303 wd = w->phys_cursor_width;
7304
7305 /* The foreground of cursor_gc is typically the same as the normal
7306 background color, which can cause the cursor box to be invisible. */
7307 xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7308 if (dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc)
7309 XChangeGC (dpy, dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc, GCForeground, &xgcv);
7310 else
7311 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = XCreateGC (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7312 GCForeground, &xgcv);
7313 gc = dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc;
7314
7315 /* Set clipping, draw the rectangle, and reset clipping again. */
7316 x_clip_to_row (w, row, TEXT_AREA, gc);
7317 XDrawRectangle (dpy, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), gc, x, y, wd, h - 1);
7318 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7319 }
7320
7321
7322 /* Draw a bar cursor on window W in glyph row ROW.
7323
7324 Implementation note: One would like to draw a bar cursor with an
7325 angle equal to the one given by the font property XA_ITALIC_ANGLE.
7326 Unfortunately, I didn't find a font yet that has this property set.
7327 --gerd. */
7328
7329 static void
7330 x_draw_bar_cursor (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *row, int width, enum text_cursor_kinds kind)
7331 {
7332 struct frame *f = XFRAME (w->frame);
7333 struct glyph *cursor_glyph;
7334
7335 /* If cursor is out of bounds, don't draw garbage. This can happen
7336 in mini-buffer windows when switching between echo area glyphs
7337 and mini-buffer. */
7338 cursor_glyph = get_phys_cursor_glyph (w);
7339 if (cursor_glyph == NULL)
7340 return;
7341
7342 /* If on an image, draw like a normal cursor. That's usually better
7343 visible than drawing a bar, esp. if the image is large so that
7344 the bar might not be in the window. */
7345 if (cursor_glyph->type == IMAGE_GLYPH)
7346 {
7347 struct glyph_row *r;
7348 r = MATRIX_ROW (w->current_matrix, w->phys_cursor.vpos);
7349 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, r, DRAW_CURSOR);
7350 }
7351 else
7352 {
7353 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
7354 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
7355 GC gc = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc;
7356 unsigned long mask = GCForeground | GCBackground | GCGraphicsExposures;
7357 struct face *face = FACE_FROM_ID (f, cursor_glyph->face_id);
7358 XGCValues xgcv;
7359
7360 /* If the glyph's background equals the color we normally draw
7361 the bars cursor in, the bar cursor in its normal color is
7362 invisible. Use the glyph's foreground color instead in this
7363 case, on the assumption that the glyph's colors are chosen so
7364 that the glyph is legible. */
7365 if (face->background == f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel)
7366 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = face->foreground;
7367 else
7368 xgcv.background = xgcv.foreground = f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel;
7369 xgcv.graphics_exposures = 0;
7370
7371 if (gc)
7372 XChangeGC (dpy, gc, mask, &xgcv);
7373 else
7374 {
7375 gc = XCreateGC (dpy, window, mask, &xgcv);
7376 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->scratch_cursor_gc = gc;
7377 }
7378
7379 x_clip_to_row (w, row, TEXT_AREA, gc);
7380
7381 if (kind == BAR_CURSOR)
7382 {
7383 int x = WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x);
7384
7385 if (width < 0)
7386 width = FRAME_CURSOR_WIDTH (f);
7387 width = min (cursor_glyph->pixel_width, width);
7388
7389 w->phys_cursor_width = width;
7390
7391 /* If the character under cursor is R2L, draw the bar cursor
7392 on the right of its glyph, rather than on the left. */
7393 if ((cursor_glyph->resolved_level & 1) != 0)
7394 x += cursor_glyph->pixel_width - width;
7395
7396 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc, x,
7397 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y),
7398 width, row->height);
7399 }
7400 else
7401 {
7402 int dummy_x, dummy_y, dummy_h;
7403
7404 if (width < 0)
7405 width = row->height;
7406
7407 width = min (row->height, width);
7408
7409 get_phys_cursor_geometry (w, row, cursor_glyph, &dummy_x,
7410 &dummy_y, &dummy_h);
7411
7412 XFillRectangle (dpy, window, gc,
7413 WINDOW_TEXT_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_X (w, w->phys_cursor.x),
7414 WINDOW_TO_FRAME_PIXEL_Y (w, w->phys_cursor.y +
7415 row->height - width),
7416 w->phys_cursor_width, width);
7417 }
7418
7419 XSetClipMask (dpy, gc, None);
7420 }
7421 }
7422
7423
7424 /* RIF: Define cursor CURSOR on frame F. */
7425
7426 static void
7427 x_define_frame_cursor (struct frame *f, Cursor cursor)
7428 {
7429 if (!f->pointer_invisible
7430 && f->output_data.x->current_cursor != cursor)
7431 XDefineCursor (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f), cursor);
7432 f->output_data.x->current_cursor = cursor;
7433 }
7434
7435
7436 /* RIF: Clear area on frame F. */
7437
7438 static void
7439 x_clear_frame_area (struct frame *f, int x, int y, int width, int height)
7440 {
7441 x_clear_area (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
7442 x, y, width, height, False);
7443 #ifdef USE_GTK
7444 /* Must queue a redraw, because scroll bars might have been cleared. */
7445 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
7446 gtk_widget_queue_draw (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f));
7447 #endif
7448 }
7449
7450
7451 /* RIF: Draw cursor on window W. */
7452
7453 static void
7454 x_draw_window_cursor (struct window *w, struct glyph_row *glyph_row, int x, int y, int cursor_type, int cursor_width, int on_p, int active_p)
7455 {
7456 struct frame *f = XFRAME (WINDOW_FRAME (w));
7457
7458 if (on_p)
7459 {
7460 w->phys_cursor_type = cursor_type;
7461 w->phys_cursor_on_p = 1;
7462
7463 if (glyph_row->exact_window_width_line_p
7464 && (glyph_row->reversed_p
7465 ? (w->phys_cursor.hpos < 0)
7466 : (w->phys_cursor.hpos >= glyph_row->used[TEXT_AREA])))
7467 {
7468 glyph_row->cursor_in_fringe_p = 1;
7469 draw_fringe_bitmap (w, glyph_row, glyph_row->reversed_p);
7470 }
7471 else
7472 {
7473 switch (cursor_type)
7474 {
7475 case HOLLOW_BOX_CURSOR:
7476 x_draw_hollow_cursor (w, glyph_row);
7477 break;
7478
7479 case FILLED_BOX_CURSOR:
7480 draw_phys_cursor_glyph (w, glyph_row, DRAW_CURSOR);
7481 break;
7482
7483 case BAR_CURSOR:
7484 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, BAR_CURSOR);
7485 break;
7486
7487 case HBAR_CURSOR:
7488 x_draw_bar_cursor (w, glyph_row, cursor_width, HBAR_CURSOR);
7489 break;
7490
7491 case NO_CURSOR:
7492 w->phys_cursor_width = 0;
7493 break;
7494
7495 default:
7496 emacs_abort ();
7497 }
7498 }
7499
7500 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
7501 if (w == XWINDOW (f->selected_window))
7502 if (FRAME_XIC (f) && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition))
7503 xic_set_preeditarea (w, x, y);
7504 #endif
7505 }
7506
7507 #ifndef XFlush
7508 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
7509 #endif
7510 }
7511
7512 \f
7513 /* Icons. */
7514
7515 /* Make the x-window of frame F use the gnu icon bitmap. */
7516
7517 int
7518 x_bitmap_icon (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object file)
7519 {
7520 ptrdiff_t bitmap_id;
7521
7522 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7523 return 1;
7524
7525 /* Free up our existing icon bitmap and mask if any. */
7526 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7527 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7528 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7529
7530 if (STRINGP (file))
7531 {
7532 #ifdef USE_GTK
7533 /* Use gtk_window_set_icon_from_file () if available,
7534 It's not restricted to bitmaps */
7535 if (xg_set_icon (f, file))
7536 return 0;
7537 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7538 bitmap_id = x_create_bitmap_from_file (f, file);
7539 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, bitmap_id);
7540 }
7541 else
7542 {
7543 /* Create the GNU bitmap and mask if necessary. */
7544 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id < 0)
7545 {
7546 ptrdiff_t rc = -1;
7547
7548 #ifdef USE_GTK
7549
7550 if (xg_set_icon (f, xg_default_icon_file)
7551 || xg_set_icon_from_xpm_data (f, gnu_xpm_bits))
7552 return 0;
7553
7554 #elif defined (HAVE_XPM) && defined (HAVE_X_WINDOWS)
7555
7556 rc = x_create_bitmap_from_xpm_data (f, gnu_xpm_bits);
7557 if (rc != -1)
7558 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id = rc;
7559
7560 #endif
7561
7562 /* If all else fails, use the (black and white) xbm image. */
7563 if (rc == -1)
7564 {
7565 rc = x_create_bitmap_from_data (f, (char *) gnu_xbm_bits,
7566 gnu_xbm_width, gnu_xbm_height);
7567 if (rc == -1)
7568 return 1;
7569
7570 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id = rc;
7571 x_create_bitmap_mask (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7572 }
7573 }
7574
7575 /* The first time we create the GNU bitmap and mask,
7576 this increments the ref-count one extra time.
7577 As a result, the GNU bitmap and mask are never freed.
7578 That way, we don't have to worry about allocating it again. */
7579 x_reference_bitmap (f, FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id);
7580
7581 bitmap_id = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->icon_bitmap_id;
7582 }
7583
7584 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, bitmap_id);
7585 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = bitmap_id;
7586
7587 return 0;
7588 }
7589
7590
7591 /* Make the x-window of frame F use a rectangle with text.
7592 Use ICON_NAME as the text. */
7593
7594 int
7595 x_text_icon (struct frame *f, const char *icon_name)
7596 {
7597 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) == 0)
7598 return 1;
7599
7600 {
7601 XTextProperty text;
7602 text.value = (unsigned char *) icon_name;
7603 text.encoding = XA_STRING;
7604 text.format = 8;
7605 text.nitems = strlen (icon_name);
7606 XSetWMIconName (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), &text);
7607 }
7608
7609 if (f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap > 0)
7610 x_destroy_bitmap (f, f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap);
7611 f->output_data.x->icon_bitmap = 0;
7612 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (f, 0);
7613
7614 return 0;
7615 }
7616 \f
7617 #define X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE 200
7618
7619 /* If non-nil, this should be a string.
7620 It means catch X errors and store the error message in this string.
7621
7622 The reason we use a stack is that x_catch_error/x_uncatch_error can
7623 be called from a signal handler.
7624 */
7625
7626 struct x_error_message_stack {
7627 char string[X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE];
7628 Display *dpy;
7629 struct x_error_message_stack *prev;
7630 };
7631 static struct x_error_message_stack *x_error_message;
7632
7633 /* An X error handler which stores the error message in
7634 *x_error_message. This is called from x_error_handler if
7635 x_catch_errors is in effect. */
7636
7637 static void
7638 x_error_catcher (Display *display, XErrorEvent *event)
7639 {
7640 XGetErrorText (display, event->error_code,
7641 x_error_message->string,
7642 X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7643 }
7644
7645 /* Begin trapping X errors for display DPY. Actually we trap X errors
7646 for all displays, but DPY should be the display you are actually
7647 operating on.
7648
7649 After calling this function, X protocol errors no longer cause
7650 Emacs to exit; instead, they are recorded in the string
7651 stored in *x_error_message.
7652
7653 Calling x_check_errors signals an Emacs error if an X error has
7654 occurred since the last call to x_catch_errors or x_check_errors.
7655
7656 Calling x_uncatch_errors resumes the normal error handling. */
7657
7658 void
7659 x_catch_errors (Display *dpy)
7660 {
7661 struct x_error_message_stack *data = xmalloc (sizeof *data);
7662
7663 /* Make sure any errors from previous requests have been dealt with. */
7664 XSync (dpy, False);
7665
7666 data->dpy = dpy;
7667 data->string[0] = 0;
7668 data->prev = x_error_message;
7669 x_error_message = data;
7670 }
7671
7672 /* Undo the last x_catch_errors call.
7673 DPY should be the display that was passed to x_catch_errors. */
7674
7675 void
7676 x_uncatch_errors (void)
7677 {
7678 struct x_error_message_stack *tmp;
7679
7680 BLOCK_INPUT;
7681
7682 /* The display may have been closed before this function is called.
7683 Check if it is still open before calling XSync. */
7684 if (x_display_info_for_display (x_error_message->dpy) != 0)
7685 XSync (x_error_message->dpy, False);
7686
7687 tmp = x_error_message;
7688 x_error_message = x_error_message->prev;
7689 xfree (tmp);
7690 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7691 }
7692
7693 /* If any X protocol errors have arrived since the last call to
7694 x_catch_errors or x_check_errors, signal an Emacs error using
7695 sprintf (a buffer, FORMAT, the x error message text) as the text. */
7696
7697 void
7698 x_check_errors (Display *dpy, const char *format)
7699 {
7700 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7701 XSync (dpy, False);
7702
7703 if (x_error_message->string[0])
7704 {
7705 char string[X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE];
7706 memcpy (string, x_error_message->string, X_ERROR_MESSAGE_SIZE);
7707 x_uncatch_errors ();
7708 error (format, string);
7709 }
7710 }
7711
7712 /* Nonzero if we had any X protocol errors
7713 since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7714
7715 int
7716 x_had_errors_p (Display *dpy)
7717 {
7718 /* Make sure to catch any errors incurred so far. */
7719 XSync (dpy, False);
7720
7721 return x_error_message->string[0] != 0;
7722 }
7723
7724 /* Forget about any errors we have had, since we did x_catch_errors on DPY. */
7725
7726 void
7727 x_clear_errors (Display *dpy)
7728 {
7729 x_error_message->string[0] = 0;
7730 }
7731
7732 #if 0 /* See comment in unwind_to_catch why calling this is a bad
7733 * idea. --lorentey */
7734 /* Close off all unclosed x_catch_errors calls. */
7735
7736 void
7737 x_fully_uncatch_errors (void)
7738 {
7739 while (x_error_message)
7740 x_uncatch_errors ();
7741 }
7742 #endif
7743
7744 #if 0
7745 static unsigned int x_wire_count;
7746 x_trace_wire (void)
7747 {
7748 fprintf (stderr, "Lib call: %d\n", ++x_wire_count);
7749 }
7750 #endif /* ! 0 */
7751
7752 \f
7753 /* Handle SIGPIPE, which can happen when the connection to a server
7754 simply goes away. SIGPIPE is handled by x_connection_signal.
7755 Don't need to do anything, because the write which caused the
7756 SIGPIPE will fail, causing Xlib to invoke the X IO error handler,
7757 which will do the appropriate cleanup for us. */
7758
7759 static void
7760 x_connection_signal (int signalnum) /* If we don't have an argument, */
7761 /* some compilers complain in signal calls. */
7762 {
7763 #ifdef USG
7764 /* USG systems forget handlers when they are used;
7765 must reestablish each time */
7766 struct sigaction action;
7767 emacs_sigaction_init (&action, x_connection_signal);
7768 sigaction (signalnum, &action, 0);
7769 #endif /* USG */
7770 }
7771
7772 \f
7773 /************************************************************************
7774 Handling X errors
7775 ************************************************************************/
7776
7777 /* Error message passed to x_connection_closed. */
7778
7779 static char *error_msg;
7780
7781 /* Handle the loss of connection to display DPY. ERROR_MESSAGE is
7782 the text of an error message that lead to the connection loss. */
7783
7784 static void
7785 x_connection_closed (Display *dpy, const char *error_message)
7786 {
7787 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = x_display_info_for_display (dpy);
7788 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
7789 ptrdiff_t idx = SPECPDL_INDEX ();
7790
7791 error_msg = alloca (strlen (error_message) + 1);
7792 strcpy (error_msg, error_message);
7793 handling_signal = 0;
7794
7795 /* Inhibit redisplay while frames are being deleted. */
7796 specbind (Qinhibit_redisplay, Qt);
7797
7798 if (dpyinfo)
7799 {
7800 /* Protect display from being closed when we delete the last
7801 frame on it. */
7802 dpyinfo->reference_count++;
7803 dpyinfo->terminal->reference_count++;
7804 }
7805
7806 /* First delete frames whose mini-buffers are on frames
7807 that are on the dead display. */
7808 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7809 {
7810 Lisp_Object minibuf_frame;
7811 minibuf_frame
7812 = WINDOW_FRAME (XWINDOW (FRAME_MINIBUF_WINDOW (XFRAME (frame))));
7813 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7814 && FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (minibuf_frame))
7815 && ! EQ (frame, minibuf_frame)
7816 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (minibuf_frame)) == dpyinfo)
7817 delete_frame (frame, Qnoelisp);
7818 }
7819
7820 /* Now delete all remaining frames on the dead display.
7821 We are now sure none of these is used as the mini-buffer
7822 for another frame that we need to delete. */
7823 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
7824 if (FRAME_X_P (XFRAME (frame))
7825 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame)) == dpyinfo)
7826 {
7827 /* Set this to t so that delete_frame won't get confused
7828 trying to find a replacement. */
7829 kset_default_minibuffer_frame (FRAME_KBOARD (XFRAME (frame)), Qt);
7830 delete_frame (frame, Qnoelisp);
7831 }
7832
7833 /* If DPYINFO is null, this means we didn't open the display in the
7834 first place, so don't try to close it. */
7835 if (dpyinfo)
7836 {
7837 /* We can not call XtCloseDisplay here because it calls XSync.
7838 XSync inside the error handler apparently hangs Emacs. On
7839 current Xt versions, this isn't needed either. */
7840 #ifdef USE_GTK
7841 /* A long-standing GTK bug prevents proper disconnect handling
7842 (https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=85715). Once,
7843 the resulting Glib error message loop filled a user's disk.
7844 To avoid this, kill Emacs unconditionally on disconnect. */
7845 shut_down_emacs (0, Qnil);
7846 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n\
7847 When compiled with GTK, Emacs cannot recover from X disconnects.\n\
7848 This is a GTK bug: https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=85715\n\
7849 For details, see etc/PROBLEMS.\n",
7850 error_msg);
7851 emacs_abort ();
7852 #endif /* USE_GTK */
7853
7854 /* Indicate that this display is dead. */
7855 dpyinfo->display = 0;
7856
7857 dpyinfo->reference_count--;
7858 dpyinfo->terminal->reference_count--;
7859 if (dpyinfo->reference_count != 0)
7860 /* We have just closed all frames on this display. */
7861 emacs_abort ();
7862
7863 {
7864 Lisp_Object tmp;
7865 XSETTERMINAL (tmp, dpyinfo->terminal);
7866 Fdelete_terminal (tmp, Qnoelisp);
7867 }
7868 }
7869
7870 if (terminal_list == 0)
7871 {
7872 fprintf (stderr, "%s\n", error_msg);
7873 Fkill_emacs (make_number (70));
7874 /* NOTREACHED */
7875 }
7876
7877 /* Ordinary stack unwind doesn't deal with these. */
7878 {
7879 sigset_t unblocked;
7880 sigemptyset (&unblocked);
7881 #ifdef SIGIO
7882 sigaddset (&unblocked, SIGIO);
7883 #endif
7884 sigaddset (&unblocked, SIGALRM);
7885 pthread_sigmask (SIG_UNBLOCK, &unblocked, 0);
7886 }
7887 TOTALLY_UNBLOCK_INPUT;
7888
7889 unbind_to (idx, Qnil);
7890 clear_waiting_for_input ();
7891
7892 /* Tell GCC not to suggest attribute 'noreturn' for this function. */
7893 IF_LINT (if (! terminal_list) return; )
7894
7895 /* Here, we absolutely have to use a non-local exit (e.g. signal, throw,
7896 longjmp), because returning from this function would get us back into
7897 Xlib's code which will directly call `exit'. */
7898 error ("%s", error_msg);
7899 }
7900
7901 /* We specifically use it before defining it, so that gcc doesn't inline it,
7902 otherwise gdb doesn't know how to properly put a breakpoint on it. */
7903 static void x_error_quitter (Display *, XErrorEvent *);
7904
7905 /* This is the first-level handler for X protocol errors.
7906 It calls x_error_quitter or x_error_catcher. */
7907
7908 static int
7909 x_error_handler (Display *display, XErrorEvent *event)
7910 {
7911 #ifdef HAVE_GTK3
7912 if (event->error_code == BadMatch
7913 && event->request_code == X_SetInputFocus
7914 && event->minor_code == 0)
7915 {
7916 return 0;
7917 }
7918 #endif
7919
7920 if (x_error_message)
7921 x_error_catcher (display, event);
7922 else
7923 x_error_quitter (display, event);
7924 return 0;
7925 }
7926
7927 /* This is the usual handler for X protocol errors.
7928 It kills all frames on the display that we got the error for.
7929 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7930
7931 /* .gdbinit puts a breakpoint here, so make sure it is not inlined. */
7932
7933 /* On older GCC versions, just putting x_error_quitter
7934 after x_error_handler prevents inlining into the former. */
7935
7936 static void NO_INLINE
7937 x_error_quitter (Display *display, XErrorEvent *event)
7938 {
7939 char buf[256], buf1[356];
7940
7941 /* Ignore BadName errors. They can happen because of fonts
7942 or colors that are not defined. */
7943
7944 if (event->error_code == BadName)
7945 return;
7946
7947 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
7948 original error handler. */
7949
7950 XGetErrorText (display, event->error_code, buf, sizeof (buf));
7951 sprintf (buf1, "X protocol error: %s on protocol request %d",
7952 buf, event->request_code);
7953 x_connection_closed (display, buf1);
7954 }
7955
7956
7957 /* This is the handler for X IO errors, always.
7958 It kills all frames on the display that we lost touch with.
7959 If that was the only one, it prints an error message and kills Emacs. */
7960
7961 static int
7962 x_io_error_quitter (Display *display)
7963 {
7964 char buf[256];
7965
7966 snprintf (buf, sizeof buf, "Connection lost to X server `%s'",
7967 DisplayString (display));
7968 x_connection_closed (display, buf);
7969 return 0;
7970 }
7971 \f
7972 /* Changing the font of the frame. */
7973
7974 /* Give frame F the font FONT-OBJECT as its default font. The return
7975 value is FONT-OBJECT. FONTSET is an ID of the fontset for the
7976 frame. If it is negative, generate a new fontset from
7977 FONT-OBJECT. */
7978
7979 Lisp_Object
7980 x_new_font (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object font_object, int fontset)
7981 {
7982 struct font *font = XFONT_OBJECT (font_object);
7983
7984 if (fontset < 0)
7985 fontset = fontset_from_font (font_object);
7986 FRAME_FONTSET (f) = fontset;
7987 if (FRAME_FONT (f) == font)
7988 /* This font is already set in frame F. There's nothing more to
7989 do. */
7990 return font_object;
7991
7992 FRAME_FONT (f) = font;
7993 FRAME_BASELINE_OFFSET (f) = font->baseline_offset;
7994 FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) = font->average_width;
7995 FRAME_SPACE_WIDTH (f) = font->space_width;
7996 FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) = FONT_HEIGHT (font);
7997
7998 compute_fringe_widths (f, 1);
7999
8000 /* Compute the scroll bar width in character columns. */
8001 if (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) > 0)
8002 {
8003 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
8004 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f)
8005 = (FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_WIDTH (f) + wid-1) / wid;
8006 }
8007 else
8008 {
8009 int wid = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
8010 FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) = (14 + wid - 1) / wid;
8011 }
8012
8013 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f) != 0)
8014 {
8015 /* Don't change the size of a tip frame; there's no point in
8016 doing it because it's done in Fx_show_tip, and it leads to
8017 problems because the tip frame has no widget. */
8018 if (NILP (tip_frame) || XFRAME (tip_frame) != f)
8019 x_set_window_size (f, 0, FRAME_COLS (f), FRAME_LINES (f));
8020 }
8021
8022 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
8023 if (FRAME_XIC (f)
8024 && (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & (XIMPreeditPosition | XIMStatusArea)))
8025 {
8026 BLOCK_INPUT;
8027 xic_set_xfontset (f, SSDATA (fontset_ascii (fontset)));
8028 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8029 }
8030 #endif
8031
8032 return font_object;
8033 }
8034
8035 \f
8036 /***********************************************************************
8037 X Input Methods
8038 ***********************************************************************/
8039
8040 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
8041
8042 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8043
8044 /* XIM destroy callback function, which is called whenever the
8045 connection to input method XIM dies. CLIENT_DATA contains a
8046 pointer to the x_display_info structure corresponding to XIM. */
8047
8048 static void
8049 xim_destroy_callback (XIM xim, XPointer client_data, XPointer call_data)
8050 {
8051 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = (struct x_display_info *) client_data;
8052 Lisp_Object frame, tail;
8053
8054 BLOCK_INPUT;
8055
8056 /* No need to call XDestroyIC.. */
8057 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
8058 {
8059 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
8060 if (FRAME_X_P (f) && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == dpyinfo)
8061 {
8062 FRAME_XIC (f) = NULL;
8063 xic_free_xfontset (f);
8064 }
8065 }
8066
8067 /* No need to call XCloseIM. */
8068 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8069 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
8070 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8071 }
8072
8073 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6 */
8074
8075 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8076 /* This isn't prototyped in OSF 5.0 or 5.1a. */
8077 extern char *XSetIMValues (XIM, ...);
8078 #endif
8079
8080 /* Open the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
8081 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name Emacs uses. */
8082
8083 static void
8084 xim_open_dpy (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, char *resource_name)
8085 {
8086 XIM xim;
8087
8088 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8089 if (use_xim)
8090 {
8091 if (dpyinfo->xim)
8092 XCloseIM (dpyinfo->xim);
8093 xim = XOpenIM (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb, resource_name,
8094 emacs_class);
8095 dpyinfo->xim = xim;
8096
8097 if (xim)
8098 {
8099 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8100 XIMCallback destroy;
8101 #endif
8102
8103 /* Get supported styles and XIM values. */
8104 XGetIMValues (xim, XNQueryInputStyle, &dpyinfo->xim_styles, NULL);
8105
8106 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6
8107 destroy.callback = xim_destroy_callback;
8108 destroy.client_data = (XPointer)dpyinfo;
8109 XSetIMValues (xim, XNDestroyCallback, &destroy, NULL);
8110 #endif
8111 }
8112 }
8113
8114 else
8115 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8116 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8117 }
8118
8119
8120 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8121
8122 /* XIM instantiate callback function, which is called whenever an XIM
8123 server is available. DISPLAY is the display of the XIM.
8124 CLIENT_DATA contains a pointer to an xim_inst_t structure created
8125 when the callback was registered. */
8126
8127 static void
8128 xim_instantiate_callback (Display *display, XPointer client_data, XPointer call_data)
8129 {
8130 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst = (struct xim_inst_t *) client_data;
8131 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = xim_inst->dpyinfo;
8132
8133 /* We don't support multiple XIM connections. */
8134 if (dpyinfo->xim)
8135 return;
8136
8137 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, xim_inst->resource_name);
8138
8139 /* Create XIC for the existing frames on the same display, as long
8140 as they have no XIC. */
8141 if (dpyinfo->xim && dpyinfo->reference_count > 0)
8142 {
8143 Lisp_Object tail, frame;
8144
8145 BLOCK_INPUT;
8146 FOR_EACH_FRAME (tail, frame)
8147 {
8148 struct frame *f = XFRAME (frame);
8149
8150 if (FRAME_X_P (f)
8151 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f) == xim_inst->dpyinfo)
8152 if (FRAME_XIC (f) == NULL)
8153 {
8154 create_frame_xic (f);
8155 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMStatusArea)
8156 xic_set_statusarea (f);
8157 if (FRAME_XIC_STYLE (f) & XIMPreeditPosition)
8158 {
8159 struct window *w = XWINDOW (f->selected_window);
8160 xic_set_preeditarea (w, w->cursor.x, w->cursor.y);
8161 }
8162 }
8163 }
8164
8165 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8166 }
8167 }
8168
8169 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8170
8171
8172 /* Open a connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO.
8173 RESOURCE_NAME is the resource name for Emacs. On X11R5, open the
8174 connection only at the first time. On X11R6, open the connection
8175 in the XIM instantiate callback function. */
8176
8177 static void
8178 xim_initialize (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo, char *resource_name)
8179 {
8180 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8181 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8182 if (use_xim)
8183 {
8184 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8185 struct xim_inst_t *xim_inst = xmalloc (sizeof *xim_inst);
8186 ptrdiff_t len;
8187
8188 dpyinfo->xim_callback_data = xim_inst;
8189 xim_inst->dpyinfo = dpyinfo;
8190 len = strlen (resource_name);
8191 xim_inst->resource_name = xmalloc (len + 1);
8192 memcpy (xim_inst->resource_name, resource_name, len + 1);
8193 XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8194 resource_name, emacs_class,
8195 xim_instantiate_callback,
8196 /* This is XPointer in XFree86
8197 but (XPointer *) on Tru64, at
8198 least, hence the configure test. */
8199 (XRegisterIMInstantiateCallback_arg6) xim_inst);
8200 #else /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8201 xim_open_dpy (dpyinfo, resource_name);
8202 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8203 }
8204 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8205 }
8206
8207
8208 /* Close the connection to the XIM server on display DPYINFO. */
8209
8210 static void
8211 xim_close_dpy (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
8212 {
8213 #ifdef HAVE_XIM
8214 if (use_xim)
8215 {
8216 #ifdef HAVE_X11R6_XIM
8217 if (dpyinfo->display)
8218 XUnregisterIMInstantiateCallback (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->xrdb,
8219 NULL, emacs_class,
8220 xim_instantiate_callback, NULL);
8221 xfree (dpyinfo->xim_callback_data->resource_name);
8222 xfree (dpyinfo->xim_callback_data);
8223 #endif /* HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8224 if (dpyinfo->display)
8225 XCloseIM (dpyinfo->xim);
8226 dpyinfo->xim = NULL;
8227 XFree (dpyinfo->xim_styles);
8228 }
8229 #endif /* HAVE_XIM */
8230 }
8231
8232 #endif /* not HAVE_X11R6_XIM */
8233
8234
8235 \f
8236 /* Calculate the absolute position in frame F
8237 from its current recorded position values and gravity. */
8238
8239 static void
8240 x_calc_absolute_position (struct frame *f)
8241 {
8242 int flags = f->size_hint_flags;
8243
8244 /* We have nothing to do if the current position
8245 is already for the top-left corner. */
8246 if (! ((flags & XNegative) || (flags & YNegative)))
8247 return;
8248
8249 /* Treat negative positions as relative to the leftmost bottommost
8250 position that fits on the screen. */
8251 if (flags & XNegative)
8252 f->left_pos = x_display_pixel_width (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
8253 - FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) + f->left_pos;
8254
8255 {
8256 int height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8257
8258 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && defined USE_MOTIF
8259 /* Something is fishy here. When using Motif, starting Emacs with
8260 `-g -0-0', the frame appears too low by a few pixels.
8261
8262 This seems to be so because initially, while Emacs is starting,
8263 the column widget's height and the frame's pixel height are
8264 different. The column widget's height is the right one. In
8265 later invocations, when Emacs is up, the frame's pixel height
8266 is right, though.
8267
8268 It's not obvious where the initial small difference comes from.
8269 2000-12-01, gerd. */
8270
8271 XtVaGetValues (f->output_data.x->column_widget, XtNheight, &height, NULL);
8272 #endif
8273
8274 if (flags & YNegative)
8275 f->top_pos = x_display_pixel_height (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
8276 - height + f->top_pos;
8277 }
8278
8279 /* The left_pos and top_pos
8280 are now relative to the top and left screen edges,
8281 so the flags should correspond. */
8282 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8283 }
8284
8285 /* CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1 when calling from Fset_frame_position,
8286 to really change the position, and 0 when calling from
8287 x_make_frame_visible (in that case, XOFF and YOFF are the current
8288 position values). It is -1 when calling from x_set_frame_parameters,
8289 which means, do adjust for borders but don't change the gravity. */
8290
8291 void
8292 x_set_offset (struct frame *f, register int xoff, register int yoff, int change_gravity)
8293 {
8294 int modified_top, modified_left;
8295
8296 if (change_gravity > 0)
8297 {
8298 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->left_before_move = f->left_pos;
8299 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->top_before_move = f->top_pos;
8300
8301 f->top_pos = yoff;
8302 f->left_pos = xoff;
8303 f->size_hint_flags &= ~ (XNegative | YNegative);
8304 if (xoff < 0)
8305 f->size_hint_flags |= XNegative;
8306 if (yoff < 0)
8307 f->size_hint_flags |= YNegative;
8308 f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8309 }
8310 x_calc_absolute_position (f);
8311
8312 BLOCK_INPUT;
8313 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8314
8315 modified_left = f->left_pos;
8316 modified_top = f->top_pos;
8317
8318 if (change_gravity != 0 && FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_A)
8319 {
8320 /* Some WMs (twm, wmaker at least) has an offset that is smaller
8321 than the WM decorations. So we use the calculated offset instead
8322 of the WM decoration sizes here (x/y_pixels_outer_diff). */
8323 modified_left += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left;
8324 modified_top += FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top;
8325 }
8326
8327 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8328 modified_left, modified_top);
8329
8330 x_sync_with_move (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos,
8331 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
8332 ? 1 : 0);
8333
8334 /* change_gravity is non-zero when this function is called from Lisp to
8335 programmatically move a frame. In that case, we call
8336 x_check_expected_move to discover if we have a "Type A" or "Type B"
8337 window manager, and, for a "Type A" window manager, adjust the position
8338 of the frame.
8339
8340 We call x_check_expected_move if a programmatic move occurred, and
8341 either the window manager type (A/B) is unknown or it is Type A but we
8342 need to compute the top/left offset adjustment for this frame. */
8343
8344 if (change_gravity != 0 &&
8345 (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN
8346 || (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type == X_WMTYPE_A
8347 && (FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left == 0
8348 && FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top == 0))))
8349 x_check_expected_move (f, modified_left, modified_top);
8350
8351 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8352 }
8353
8354 /* Return non-zero if _NET_SUPPORTING_WM_CHECK window exists and _NET_SUPPORTED
8355 on the root window for frame F contains ATOMNAME.
8356 This is how a WM check shall be done according to the Window Manager
8357 Specification/Extended Window Manager Hints at
8358 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/wm-spec. */
8359
8360 static int
8361 wm_supports (struct frame *f, Atom want_atom)
8362 {
8363 Atom actual_type;
8364 unsigned long actual_size, bytes_remaining;
8365 int i, rc, actual_format;
8366 Window wmcheck_window;
8367 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8368 Window target_window = dpyinfo->root_window;
8369 long max_len = 65536;
8370 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
8371 unsigned char *tmp_data = NULL;
8372 Atom target_type = XA_WINDOW;
8373
8374 BLOCK_INPUT;
8375
8376 x_catch_errors (dpy);
8377 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, target_window,
8378 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supporting_wm_check,
8379 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8380 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8381 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8382
8383 if (rc != Success || actual_type != XA_WINDOW || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8384 {
8385 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8386 x_uncatch_errors ();
8387 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8388 return 0;
8389 }
8390
8391 wmcheck_window = *(Window *) tmp_data;
8392 XFree (tmp_data);
8393
8394 /* Check if window exists. */
8395 XSelectInput (dpy, wmcheck_window, StructureNotifyMask);
8396 x_sync (f);
8397 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8398 {
8399 x_uncatch_errors ();
8400 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8401 return 0;
8402 }
8403
8404 if (dpyinfo->net_supported_window != wmcheck_window)
8405 {
8406 /* Window changed, reload atoms */
8407 if (dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms != NULL)
8408 XFree (dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms);
8409 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = NULL;
8410 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = 0;
8411 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = 0;
8412
8413 target_type = XA_ATOM;
8414 tmp_data = NULL;
8415 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, target_window,
8416 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supported,
8417 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8418 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8419 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8420
8421 if (rc != Success || actual_type != XA_ATOM || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8422 {
8423 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8424 x_uncatch_errors ();
8425 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8426 return 0;
8427 }
8428
8429 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = (Atom *)tmp_data;
8430 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = actual_size;
8431 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = wmcheck_window;
8432 }
8433
8434 rc = 0;
8435
8436 for (i = 0; rc == 0 && i < dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms; ++i)
8437 rc = dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms[i] == want_atom;
8438
8439 x_uncatch_errors ();
8440 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8441
8442 return rc;
8443 }
8444
8445 static void
8446 set_wm_state (Lisp_Object frame, int add, Atom atom, Atom value)
8447 {
8448 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (XFRAME (frame));
8449
8450 x_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
8451 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state,
8452 make_number (32),
8453 /* 1 = add, 0 = remove */
8454 Fcons
8455 (make_number (add ? 1 : 0),
8456 Fcons
8457 (make_fixnum_or_float (atom),
8458 value != 0
8459 ? Fcons (make_fixnum_or_float (value), Qnil)
8460 : Qnil)));
8461 }
8462
8463 void
8464 x_set_sticky (struct frame *f, Lisp_Object new_value, Lisp_Object old_value)
8465 {
8466 Lisp_Object frame;
8467 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8468
8469 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8470
8471 set_wm_state (frame, NILP (new_value) ? 0 : 1,
8472 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky, None);
8473 }
8474
8475 /* Return the current _NET_WM_STATE.
8476 SIZE_STATE is set to one of the FULLSCREEN_* values.
8477 STICKY is set to 1 if the sticky state is set, 0 if not.
8478
8479 Return non-zero if we are not hidden, zero if we are. */
8480
8481 static int
8482 get_current_wm_state (struct frame *f,
8483 Window window,
8484 int *size_state,
8485 int *sticky)
8486 {
8487 Atom actual_type;
8488 unsigned long actual_size, bytes_remaining;
8489 int i, rc, actual_format, is_hidden = 0;
8490 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8491 long max_len = 65536;
8492 Display *dpy = FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f);
8493 unsigned char *tmp_data = NULL;
8494 Atom target_type = XA_ATOM;
8495
8496 *sticky = 0;
8497 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
8498
8499 BLOCK_INPUT;
8500 x_catch_errors (dpy);
8501 rc = XGetWindowProperty (dpy, window, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state,
8502 0, max_len, False, target_type,
8503 &actual_type, &actual_format, &actual_size,
8504 &bytes_remaining, &tmp_data);
8505
8506 if (rc != Success || actual_type != target_type || x_had_errors_p (dpy))
8507 {
8508 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8509 x_uncatch_errors ();
8510 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8511 return ! f->iconified;
8512 }
8513
8514 x_uncatch_errors ();
8515
8516 for (i = 0; i < actual_size; ++i)
8517 {
8518 Atom a = ((Atom*)tmp_data)[i];
8519 if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_hidden)
8520 {
8521 is_hidden = 1;
8522 f->output_data.x->net_wm_state_hidden_seen = 1;
8523 }
8524 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz)
8525 {
8526 if (*size_state == FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT)
8527 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED;
8528 else
8529 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_WIDTH;
8530 }
8531 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert)
8532 {
8533 if (*size_state == FULLSCREEN_WIDTH)
8534 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED;
8535 else
8536 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT;
8537 }
8538 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen)
8539 *size_state = FULLSCREEN_BOTH;
8540 else if (a == dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky)
8541 *sticky = 1;
8542 }
8543
8544 if (tmp_data) XFree (tmp_data);
8545 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8546 return ! is_hidden;
8547 }
8548
8549 /* Do fullscreen as specified in extended window manager hints */
8550
8551 static int
8552 do_ewmh_fullscreen (struct frame *f)
8553 {
8554 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8555 int have_net_atom = wm_supports (f, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state);
8556 int cur, dummy;
8557
8558 (void)get_current_wm_state (f, FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f), &cur, &dummy);
8559
8560 /* Some window managers don't say they support _NET_WM_STATE, but they do say
8561 they support _NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN. Try that also. */
8562 if (!have_net_atom)
8563 have_net_atom = wm_supports (f, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen);
8564
8565 if (have_net_atom && cur != f->want_fullscreen)
8566 {
8567 Lisp_Object frame;
8568
8569 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
8570
8571 /* Keep number of calls to set_wm_state as low as possible.
8572 Some window managers, or possible Gtk+, hangs when too many
8573 are sent at once. */
8574 switch (f->want_fullscreen)
8575 {
8576 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8577 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_WIDTH || cur == FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED
8578 || cur == FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT)
8579 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz,
8580 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8581 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen, None);
8582 break;
8583 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8584 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH || cur == FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT
8585 || cur == FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8586 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen,
8587 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8588 if (cur != FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8589 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz, None);
8590 break;
8591 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8592 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH || cur == FULLSCREEN_WIDTH
8593 || cur == FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8594 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen,
8595 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz);
8596 if (cur != FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED)
8597 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert, None);
8598 break;
8599 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
8600 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH)
8601 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen, None);
8602 set_wm_state (frame, 1, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz,
8603 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8604 break;
8605 case FULLSCREEN_NONE:
8606 if (cur == FULLSCREEN_BOTH)
8607 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen, None);
8608 else
8609 set_wm_state (frame, 0, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz,
8610 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert);
8611 }
8612
8613 f->want_fullscreen = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
8614
8615 }
8616
8617 return have_net_atom;
8618 }
8619
8620 static void
8621 XTfullscreen_hook (FRAME_PTR f)
8622 {
8623 if (f->async_visible)
8624 {
8625 BLOCK_INPUT;
8626 x_check_fullscreen (f);
8627 x_sync (f);
8628 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8629 }
8630 }
8631
8632
8633 static int
8634 x_handle_net_wm_state (struct frame *f, XPropertyEvent *event)
8635 {
8636 int value = FULLSCREEN_NONE;
8637 Lisp_Object lval;
8638 int sticky = 0;
8639 int not_hidden = get_current_wm_state (f, event->window, &value, &sticky);
8640
8641 lval = Qnil;
8642 switch (value)
8643 {
8644 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8645 lval = Qfullwidth;
8646 break;
8647 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8648 lval = Qfullheight;
8649 break;
8650 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8651 lval = Qfullboth;
8652 break;
8653 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
8654 lval = Qmaximized;
8655 break;
8656 }
8657
8658 store_frame_param (f, Qfullscreen, lval);
8659 store_frame_param (f, Qsticky, sticky ? Qt : Qnil);
8660
8661 return not_hidden;
8662 }
8663
8664 /* Check if we need to resize the frame due to a fullscreen request.
8665 If so needed, resize the frame. */
8666 static void
8667 x_check_fullscreen (struct frame *f)
8668 {
8669 if (do_ewmh_fullscreen (f))
8670 return;
8671
8672 if (f->output_data.x->parent_desc != FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->root_window)
8673 return; /* Only fullscreen without WM or with EWM hints (above). */
8674
8675 /* Setting fullscreen to nil doesn't do anything. We could save the
8676 last non-fullscreen size and restore it, but it seems like a
8677 lot of work for this unusual case (no window manager running). */
8678
8679 if (f->want_fullscreen != FULLSCREEN_NONE)
8680 {
8681 int width = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f), height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8682 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
8683
8684 switch (f->want_fullscreen)
8685 {
8686 /* No difference between these two when there is no WM */
8687 case FULLSCREEN_BOTH:
8688 case FULLSCREEN_MAXIMIZED:
8689 width = x_display_pixel_width (dpyinfo);
8690 height = x_display_pixel_height (dpyinfo);
8691 break;
8692 case FULLSCREEN_WIDTH:
8693 width = x_display_pixel_width (dpyinfo);
8694 break;
8695 case FULLSCREEN_HEIGHT:
8696 height = x_display_pixel_height (dpyinfo);
8697 }
8698
8699 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8700 width, height);
8701 }
8702 }
8703
8704 /* This function is called by x_set_offset to determine whether the window
8705 manager interfered with the positioning of the frame. Type A window
8706 managers position the surrounding window manager decorations a small
8707 amount above and left of the user-supplied position. Type B window
8708 managers position the surrounding window manager decorations at the
8709 user-specified position. If we detect a Type A window manager, we
8710 compensate by moving the window right and down by the proper amount. */
8711
8712 static void
8713 x_check_expected_move (struct frame *f, int expected_left, int expected_top)
8714 {
8715 int current_left = 0, current_top = 0;
8716
8717 /* x_real_positions returns the left and top offsets of the outermost
8718 window manager window around the frame. */
8719
8720 x_real_positions (f, &current_left, &current_top);
8721
8722 if (current_left != expected_left || current_top != expected_top)
8723 {
8724 /* It's a "Type A" window manager. */
8725
8726 int adjusted_left;
8727 int adjusted_top;
8728
8729 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_A;
8730 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left = expected_left - current_left;
8731 FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top = expected_top - current_top;
8732
8733 /* Now fix the mispositioned frame's location. */
8734
8735 adjusted_left = expected_left + FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_left;
8736 adjusted_top = expected_top + FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->move_offset_top;
8737
8738 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8739 adjusted_left, adjusted_top);
8740
8741 x_sync_with_move (f, expected_left, expected_top, 0);
8742 }
8743 else
8744 /* It's a "Type B" window manager. We don't have to adjust the
8745 frame's position. */
8746
8747 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_B;
8748 }
8749
8750
8751 /* Wait for XGetGeometry to return up-to-date position information for a
8752 recently-moved frame. Call this immediately after calling XMoveWindow.
8753 If FUZZY is non-zero, then LEFT and TOP are just estimates of where the
8754 frame has been moved to, so we use a fuzzy position comparison instead
8755 of an exact comparison. */
8756
8757 static void
8758 x_sync_with_move (struct frame *f, int left, int top, int fuzzy)
8759 {
8760 int count = 0;
8761
8762 while (count++ < 50)
8763 {
8764 int current_left = 0, current_top = 0;
8765
8766 /* In theory, this call to XSync only needs to happen once, but in
8767 practice, it doesn't seem to work, hence the need for the surrounding
8768 loop. */
8769
8770 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
8771 x_real_positions (f, &current_left, &current_top);
8772
8773 if (fuzzy)
8774 {
8775 /* The left fuzz-factor is 10 pixels. The top fuzz-factor is 40
8776 pixels. */
8777
8778 if (eabs (current_left - left) <= 10
8779 && eabs (current_top - top) <= 40)
8780 return;
8781 }
8782 else if (current_left == left && current_top == top)
8783 return;
8784 }
8785
8786 /* As a last resort, just wait 0.5 seconds and hope that XGetGeometry
8787 will then return up-to-date position info. */
8788
8789 wait_reading_process_output (0, 500000, 0, 0, Qnil, NULL, 0);
8790 }
8791
8792
8793 /* Wait for an event on frame F matching EVENTTYPE. */
8794 void
8795 x_wait_for_event (struct frame *f, int eventtype)
8796 {
8797 int level = interrupt_input_blocked;
8798
8799 SELECT_TYPE fds;
8800 EMACS_TIME tmo, tmo_at, time_now;
8801 int fd = ConnectionNumber (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
8802
8803 pending_event_wait.f = f;
8804 pending_event_wait.eventtype = eventtype;
8805
8806 /* Set timeout to 0.1 second. Hopefully not noticeable.
8807 Maybe it should be configurable. */
8808 tmo = make_emacs_time (0, 100 * 1000 * 1000);
8809 tmo_at = add_emacs_time (current_emacs_time (), tmo);
8810
8811 while (pending_event_wait.eventtype)
8812 {
8813 interrupt_input_pending = 1;
8814 TOTALLY_UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8815 /* XTread_socket is called after unblock. */
8816 BLOCK_INPUT;
8817 interrupt_input_blocked = level;
8818
8819 FD_ZERO (&fds);
8820 FD_SET (fd, &fds);
8821
8822 time_now = current_emacs_time ();
8823 if (EMACS_TIME_LT (tmo_at, time_now))
8824 break;
8825
8826 tmo = sub_emacs_time (tmo_at, time_now);
8827 if (pselect (fd + 1, &fds, NULL, NULL, &tmo, NULL) == 0)
8828 break; /* Timeout */
8829 }
8830 pending_event_wait.f = 0;
8831 pending_event_wait.eventtype = 0;
8832 }
8833
8834
8835 /* Change the size of frame F's X window to COLS/ROWS in the case F
8836 doesn't have a widget. If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to
8837 top-left-corner window gravity for this size change and subsequent
8838 size changes. Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8839
8840 static void
8841 x_set_window_size_1 (struct frame *f, int change_gravity, int cols, int rows)
8842 {
8843 int pixelwidth, pixelheight;
8844
8845 check_frame_size (f, &rows, &cols);
8846 f->scroll_bar_actual_width
8847 = (!FRAME_HAS_VERTICAL_SCROLL_BARS (f)
8848 ? 0
8849 : FRAME_CONFIG_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f));
8850
8851 compute_fringe_widths (f, 0);
8852
8853 pixelwidth = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, cols)
8854 + FRAME_TOOLBAR_WIDTH (f);
8855 pixelheight = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, rows)
8856 + FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f) + FRAME_TOOLBAR_HEIGHT (f);
8857
8858 if (change_gravity) f->win_gravity = NorthWestGravity;
8859 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 0);
8860 XResizeWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
8861 pixelwidth, pixelheight);
8862
8863
8864 /* We've set {FRAME,PIXEL}_{WIDTH,HEIGHT} to the values we hope to
8865 receive in the ConfigureNotify event; if we get what we asked
8866 for, then the event won't cause the screen to become garbaged, so
8867 we have to make sure to do it here. */
8868 SET_FRAME_GARBAGED (f);
8869
8870 /* Now, strictly speaking, we can't be sure that this is accurate,
8871 but the window manager will get around to dealing with the size
8872 change request eventually, and we'll hear how it went when the
8873 ConfigureNotify event gets here.
8874
8875 We could just not bother storing any of this information here,
8876 and let the ConfigureNotify event set everything up, but that
8877 might be kind of confusing to the Lisp code, since size changes
8878 wouldn't be reported in the frame parameters until some random
8879 point in the future when the ConfigureNotify event arrives.
8880
8881 We pass 1 for DELAY since we can't run Lisp code inside of
8882 a BLOCK_INPUT. */
8883
8884 /* But the ConfigureNotify may in fact never arrive, and then this is
8885 not right if the frame is visible. Instead wait (with timeout)
8886 for the ConfigureNotify. */
8887 if (f->async_visible)
8888 x_wait_for_event (f, ConfigureNotify);
8889 else
8890 {
8891 change_frame_size (f, rows, cols, 0, 1, 0);
8892 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f) = pixelwidth;
8893 FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f) = pixelheight;
8894 x_sync (f);
8895 }
8896 }
8897
8898
8899 /* Call this to change the size of frame F's x-window.
8900 If CHANGE_GRAVITY is 1, we change to top-left-corner window gravity
8901 for this size change and subsequent size changes.
8902 Otherwise we leave the window gravity unchanged. */
8903
8904 void
8905 x_set_window_size (struct frame *f, int change_gravity, int cols, int rows)
8906 {
8907 BLOCK_INPUT;
8908
8909 if (NILP (tip_frame) || XFRAME (tip_frame) != f)
8910 {
8911 int r, c;
8912
8913 /* When the frame is maximized/fullscreen or running under for
8914 example Xmonad, x_set_window_size_1 will be a no-op.
8915 In that case, the right thing to do is extend rows/cols to
8916 the current frame size. We do that first if x_set_window_size_1
8917 turns out to not be a no-op (there is no way to know).
8918 The size will be adjusted again if the frame gets a
8919 ConfigureNotify event as a result of x_set_window_size. */
8920 int pixelh = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8921 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
8922 /* The menu bar is not part of text lines. The tool bar
8923 is however. */
8924 pixelh -= FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f);
8925 #endif
8926 r = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT_TO_TEXT_LINES (f, pixelh);
8927 /* Update f->scroll_bar_actual_width because it is used in
8928 FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS. */
8929 f->scroll_bar_actual_width
8930 = FRAME_SCROLL_BAR_COLS (f) * FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
8931 c = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH_TO_TEXT_COLS (f, FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f));
8932 change_frame_size (f, r, c, 0, 1, 0);
8933 }
8934
8935 #ifdef USE_GTK
8936 if (FRAME_GTK_WIDGET (f))
8937 xg_frame_set_char_size (f, cols, rows);
8938 else
8939 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8940 #else /* not USE_GTK */
8941
8942 x_set_window_size_1 (f, change_gravity, cols, rows);
8943
8944 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
8945
8946 /* If cursor was outside the new size, mark it as off. */
8947 mark_window_cursors_off (XWINDOW (f->root_window));
8948
8949 /* Clear out any recollection of where the mouse highlighting was,
8950 since it might be in a place that's outside the new frame size.
8951 Actually checking whether it is outside is a pain in the neck,
8952 so don't try--just let the highlighting be done afresh with new size. */
8953 cancel_mouse_face (f);
8954
8955 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8956 }
8957 \f
8958 /* Mouse warping. */
8959
8960 void
8961 x_set_mouse_position (struct frame *f, int x, int y)
8962 {
8963 int pix_x, pix_y;
8964
8965 pix_x = FRAME_COL_TO_PIXEL_X (f, x) + FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f) / 2;
8966 pix_y = FRAME_LINE_TO_PIXEL_Y (f, y) + FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f) / 2;
8967
8968 if (pix_x < 0) pix_x = 0;
8969 if (pix_x > FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f)) pix_x = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
8970
8971 if (pix_y < 0) pix_y = 0;
8972 if (pix_y > FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f)) pix_y = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
8973
8974 BLOCK_INPUT;
8975
8976 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8977 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
8978 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8979 }
8980
8981 /* Move the mouse to position pixel PIX_X, PIX_Y relative to frame F. */
8982
8983 void
8984 x_set_mouse_pixel_position (struct frame *f, int pix_x, int pix_y)
8985 {
8986 BLOCK_INPUT;
8987
8988 XWarpPointer (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), None, FRAME_X_WINDOW (f),
8989 0, 0, 0, 0, pix_x, pix_y);
8990 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
8991 }
8992 \f
8993 /* Raise frame F. */
8994
8995 void
8996 x_raise_frame (struct frame *f)
8997 {
8998 BLOCK_INPUT;
8999 if (f->async_visible)
9000 XRaiseWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
9001
9002 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9003 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9004 }
9005
9006 /* Lower frame F. */
9007
9008 static void
9009 x_lower_frame (struct frame *f)
9010 {
9011 if (f->async_visible)
9012 {
9013 BLOCK_INPUT;
9014 XLowerWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f));
9015 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9016 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9017 }
9018 }
9019
9020 /* Request focus with XEmbed */
9021
9022 void
9023 xembed_request_focus (FRAME_PTR f)
9024 {
9025 /* See XEmbed Protocol Specification at
9026 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/xembed-spec */
9027 if (f->async_visible)
9028 xembed_send_message (f, CurrentTime,
9029 XEMBED_REQUEST_FOCUS, 0, 0, 0);
9030 }
9031
9032 /* Activate frame with Extended Window Manager Hints */
9033
9034 void
9035 x_ewmh_activate_frame (FRAME_PTR f)
9036 {
9037 /* See Window Manager Specification/Extended Window Manager Hints at
9038 http://freedesktop.org/wiki/Specifications/wm-spec */
9039
9040 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9041 if (f->async_visible && wm_supports (f, dpyinfo->Xatom_net_active_window))
9042 {
9043 Lisp_Object frame;
9044 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
9045 x_send_client_event (frame, make_number (0), frame,
9046 dpyinfo->Xatom_net_active_window,
9047 make_number (32),
9048 Fcons (make_number (1),
9049 Fcons (make_number (last_user_time),
9050 Qnil)));
9051 }
9052 }
9053
9054 static void
9055 XTframe_raise_lower (FRAME_PTR f, int raise_flag)
9056 {
9057 if (raise_flag)
9058 x_raise_frame (f);
9059 else
9060 x_lower_frame (f);
9061 }
9062 \f
9063 /* XEmbed implementation. */
9064
9065 #if defined USE_X_TOOLKIT || ! defined USE_GTK
9066
9067 /* XEmbed implementation. */
9068
9069 #define XEMBED_VERSION 0
9070
9071 static void
9072 xembed_set_info (struct frame *f, enum xembed_info flags)
9073 {
9074 unsigned long data[2];
9075 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9076
9077 data[0] = XEMBED_VERSION;
9078 data[1] = flags;
9079
9080 XChangeProperty (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
9081 dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED_INFO, dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED_INFO,
9082 32, PropModeReplace, (unsigned char *) data, 2);
9083 }
9084 #endif /* defined USE_X_TOOLKIT || ! defined USE_GTK */
9085
9086 static void
9087 xembed_send_message (struct frame *f, Time t, enum xembed_message msg,
9088 long int detail, long int data1, long int data2)
9089 {
9090 XEvent event;
9091
9092 event.xclient.type = ClientMessage;
9093 event.xclient.window = FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->parent_desc;
9094 event.xclient.message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_XEMBED;
9095 event.xclient.format = 32;
9096 event.xclient.data.l[0] = t;
9097 event.xclient.data.l[1] = msg;
9098 event.xclient.data.l[2] = detail;
9099 event.xclient.data.l[3] = data1;
9100 event.xclient.data.l[4] = data2;
9101
9102 XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_OUTPUT (f)->parent_desc,
9103 False, NoEventMask, &event);
9104 XSync (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), False);
9105 }
9106 \f
9107 /* Change of visibility. */
9108
9109 /* This tries to wait until the frame is really visible.
9110 However, if the window manager asks the user where to position
9111 the frame, this will return before the user finishes doing that.
9112 The frame will not actually be visible at that time,
9113 but it will become visible later when the window manager
9114 finishes with it. */
9115
9116 void
9117 x_make_frame_visible (struct frame *f)
9118 {
9119 Lisp_Object type;
9120 int original_top, original_left;
9121 int retry_count = 2;
9122
9123 retry:
9124
9125 BLOCK_INPUT;
9126
9127 type = x_icon_type (f);
9128 if (!NILP (type))
9129 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
9130
9131 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9132 {
9133 /* We test FRAME_GARBAGED_P here to make sure we don't
9134 call x_set_offset a second time
9135 if we get to x_make_frame_visible a second time
9136 before the window gets really visible. */
9137 if (! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
9138 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f)
9139 && ! f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible)
9140 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
9141
9142 f->output_data.x->asked_for_visible = 1;
9143
9144 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
9145 x_wm_set_window_state (f, NormalState);
9146 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9147 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9148 xembed_set_info (f, XEMBED_MAPPED);
9149 else
9150 {
9151 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
9152 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9153 }
9154 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9155 #ifdef USE_GTK
9156 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9157 gtk_window_deiconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
9158 #else
9159 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9160 xembed_set_info (f, XEMBED_MAPPED);
9161 else
9162 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9163 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9164 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9165 }
9166
9167 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9168
9169 /* Synchronize to ensure Emacs knows the frame is visible
9170 before we do anything else. We do this loop with input not blocked
9171 so that incoming events are handled. */
9172 {
9173 Lisp_Object frame;
9174 int count;
9175 /* This must be before UNBLOCK_INPUT
9176 since events that arrive in response to the actions above
9177 will set it when they are handled. */
9178 int previously_visible = f->output_data.x->has_been_visible;
9179
9180 original_left = f->left_pos;
9181 original_top = f->top_pos;
9182
9183 /* This must come after we set COUNT. */
9184 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9185
9186 /* We unblock here so that arriving X events are processed. */
9187
9188 /* Now move the window back to where it was "supposed to be".
9189 But don't do it if the gravity is negative.
9190 When the gravity is negative, this uses a position
9191 that is 3 pixels too low. Perhaps that's really the border width.
9192
9193 Don't do this if the window has never been visible before,
9194 because the window manager may choose the position
9195 and we don't want to override it. */
9196
9197 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f)
9198 && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
9199 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f)
9200 && f->win_gravity == NorthWestGravity
9201 && previously_visible)
9202 {
9203 Drawable rootw;
9204 int x, y;
9205 unsigned int width, height, border, depth;
9206
9207 BLOCK_INPUT;
9208
9209 /* On some window managers (such as FVWM) moving an existing
9210 window, even to the same place, causes the window manager
9211 to introduce an offset. This can cause the window to move
9212 to an unexpected location. Check the geometry (a little
9213 slow here) and then verify that the window is in the right
9214 place. If the window is not in the right place, move it
9215 there, and take the potential window manager hit. */
9216 XGetGeometry (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
9217 &rootw, &x, &y, &width, &height, &border, &depth);
9218
9219 if (original_left != x || original_top != y)
9220 XMoveWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f),
9221 original_left, original_top);
9222
9223 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9224 }
9225
9226 XSETFRAME (frame, f);
9227
9228 /* Wait until the frame is visible. Process X events until a
9229 MapNotify event has been seen, or until we think we won't get a
9230 MapNotify at all.. */
9231 for (count = input_signal_count + 10;
9232 input_signal_count < count && !FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f);)
9233 {
9234 /* Force processing of queued events. */
9235 x_sync (f);
9236
9237 /* Machines that do polling rather than SIGIO have been
9238 observed to go into a busy-wait here. So we'll fake an
9239 alarm signal to let the handler know that there's something
9240 to be read. We used to raise a real alarm, but it seems
9241 that the handler isn't always enabled here. This is
9242 probably a bug. */
9243 if (input_polling_used ())
9244 {
9245 /* It could be confusing if a real alarm arrives while
9246 processing the fake one. Turn it off and let the
9247 handler reset it. */
9248 int old_poll_suppress_count = poll_suppress_count;
9249 poll_suppress_count = 1;
9250 poll_for_input_1 ();
9251 poll_suppress_count = old_poll_suppress_count;
9252 }
9253
9254 /* See if a MapNotify event has been processed. */
9255 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
9256 }
9257
9258 /* 2000-09-28: In
9259
9260 (let ((f (selected-frame)))
9261 (iconify-frame f)
9262 (raise-frame f))
9263
9264 the frame is not raised with various window managers on
9265 FreeBSD, GNU/Linux and Solaris. It turns out that, for some
9266 unknown reason, the call to XtMapWidget is completely ignored.
9267 Mapping the widget a second time works. */
9268
9269 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f) && --retry_count != 0)
9270 goto retry;
9271 }
9272 }
9273
9274 /* Change from mapped state to withdrawn state. */
9275
9276 /* Make the frame visible (mapped and not iconified). */
9277
9278 void
9279 x_make_frame_invisible (struct frame *f)
9280 {
9281 Window window;
9282
9283 /* Use the frame's outermost window, not the one we normally draw on. */
9284 window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9285
9286 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
9287 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
9288 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9289
9290 BLOCK_INPUT;
9291
9292 /* Before unmapping the window, update the WM_SIZE_HINTS property to claim
9293 that the current position of the window is user-specified, rather than
9294 program-specified, so that when the window is mapped again, it will be
9295 placed at the same location, without forcing the user to position it
9296 by hand again (they have already done that once for this window.) */
9297 x_wm_set_size_hint (f, (long) 0, 1);
9298
9299 #ifdef USE_GTK
9300 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
9301 gtk_widget_hide (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9302 else
9303 #else
9304 if (FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9305 xembed_set_info (f, 0);
9306 else
9307 #endif
9308 {
9309
9310 if (! XWithdrawWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window,
9311 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f))))
9312 {
9313 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
9314 error ("Can't notify window manager of window withdrawal");
9315 }
9316 }
9317
9318 /* We can't distinguish this from iconification
9319 just by the event that we get from the server.
9320 So we can't win using the usual strategy of letting
9321 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY set this. So do it by hand,
9322 and synchronize with the server to make sure we agree. */
9323 f->visible = 0;
9324 FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f) = 0;
9325 f->async_visible = 0;
9326 f->async_iconified = 0;
9327
9328 x_sync (f);
9329
9330 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9331 }
9332
9333 /* Change window state from mapped to iconified. */
9334
9335 void
9336 x_iconify_frame (struct frame *f)
9337 {
9338 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9339 int result;
9340 #endif
9341 Lisp_Object type;
9342
9343 /* Don't keep the highlight on an invisible frame. */
9344 if (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame == f)
9345 FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9346
9347 if (f->async_iconified)
9348 return;
9349
9350 BLOCK_INPUT;
9351
9352 FRAME_SAMPLE_VISIBILITY (f);
9353
9354 type = x_icon_type (f);
9355 if (!NILP (type))
9356 x_bitmap_icon (f, type);
9357
9358 #if defined (USE_GTK)
9359 if (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f))
9360 {
9361 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9362 gtk_widget_show_all (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f));
9363
9364 gtk_window_iconify (GTK_WINDOW (FRAME_GTK_OUTER_WIDGET (f)));
9365 f->iconified = 1;
9366 f->visible = 1;
9367 f->async_iconified = 1;
9368 f->async_visible = 0;
9369 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9370 return;
9371 }
9372 #endif
9373
9374 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9375
9376 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9377 {
9378 if (! EQ (Vx_no_window_manager, Qt))
9379 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
9380 /* This was XtPopup, but that did nothing for an iconified frame. */
9381 XtMapWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9382 /* The server won't give us any event to indicate
9383 that an invisible frame was changed to an icon,
9384 so we have to record it here. */
9385 f->iconified = 1;
9386 f->visible = 1;
9387 f->async_iconified = 1;
9388 f->async_visible = 0;
9389 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9390 return;
9391 }
9392
9393 result = XIconifyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
9394 XtWindow (f->output_data.x->widget),
9395 DefaultScreen (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)));
9396 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9397
9398 if (!result)
9399 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
9400
9401 f->async_iconified = 1;
9402 f->async_visible = 0;
9403
9404
9405 BLOCK_INPUT;
9406 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9407 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9408 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9409
9410 /* Make sure the X server knows where the window should be positioned,
9411 in case the user deiconifies with the window manager. */
9412 if (! FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f)
9413 && ! FRAME_ICONIFIED_P (f)
9414 && ! FRAME_X_EMBEDDED_P (f))
9415 x_set_offset (f, f->left_pos, f->top_pos, 0);
9416
9417 /* Since we don't know which revision of X we're running, we'll use both
9418 the X11R3 and X11R4 techniques. I don't know if this is a good idea. */
9419
9420 /* X11R4: send a ClientMessage to the window manager using the
9421 WM_CHANGE_STATE type. */
9422 {
9423 XEvent msg;
9424
9425 msg.xclient.window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
9426 msg.xclient.type = ClientMessage;
9427 msg.xclient.message_type = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f)->Xatom_wm_change_state;
9428 msg.xclient.format = 32;
9429 msg.xclient.data.l[0] = IconicState;
9430
9431 if (! XSendEvent (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f),
9432 DefaultRootWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f)),
9433 False,
9434 SubstructureRedirectMask | SubstructureNotifyMask,
9435 &msg))
9436 {
9437 UNBLOCK_INPUT_RESIGNAL;
9438 error ("Can't notify window manager of iconification");
9439 }
9440 }
9441
9442 /* X11R3: set the initial_state field of the window manager hints to
9443 IconicState. */
9444 x_wm_set_window_state (f, IconicState);
9445
9446 if (!FRAME_VISIBLE_P (f))
9447 {
9448 /* If the frame was withdrawn, before, we must map it. */
9449 XMapRaised (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9450 }
9451
9452 f->async_iconified = 1;
9453 f->async_visible = 0;
9454
9455 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9456 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9457 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9458 }
9459
9460 \f
9461 /* Free X resources of frame F. */
9462
9463 void
9464 x_free_frame_resources (struct frame *f)
9465 {
9466 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9467 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo = &dpyinfo->mouse_highlight;
9468 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9469 Lisp_Object bar;
9470 struct scroll_bar *b;
9471 #endif
9472
9473 BLOCK_INPUT;
9474
9475 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
9476 commands to the X server. */
9477 if (dpyinfo->display)
9478 {
9479 /* We must free faces before destroying windows because some
9480 font-driver (e.g. xft) access a window while finishing a
9481 face. */
9482 if (FRAME_FACE_CACHE (f))
9483 free_frame_faces (f);
9484
9485 if (f->output_data.x->icon_desc)
9486 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), f->output_data.x->icon_desc);
9487
9488 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9489 /* Explicitly destroy the scroll bars of the frame. Without
9490 this, we get "BadDrawable" errors from the toolkit later on,
9491 presumably from expose events generated for the disappearing
9492 toolkit scroll bars. */
9493 for (bar = FRAME_SCROLL_BARS (f); !NILP (bar); bar = b->next)
9494 {
9495 b = XSCROLL_BAR (bar);
9496 x_scroll_bar_remove (b);
9497 }
9498 #endif
9499
9500 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
9501 if (FRAME_XIC (f))
9502 free_frame_xic (f);
9503 #endif
9504
9505 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9506 if (f->output_data.x->widget)
9507 {
9508 XtDestroyWidget (f->output_data.x->widget);
9509 f->output_data.x->widget = NULL;
9510 }
9511 /* Tooltips don't have widgets, only a simple X window, even if
9512 we are using a toolkit. */
9513 else if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
9514 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9515
9516 free_frame_menubar (f);
9517 #else /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9518
9519 #ifdef USE_GTK
9520 xg_free_frame_widgets (f);
9521 #endif /* USE_GTK */
9522
9523 if (FRAME_X_WINDOW (f))
9524 XDestroyWindow (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), FRAME_X_WINDOW (f));
9525 #endif /* !USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9526
9527 unload_color (f, FRAME_FOREGROUND_PIXEL (f));
9528 unload_color (f, FRAME_BACKGROUND_PIXEL (f));
9529 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_pixel);
9530 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->cursor_foreground_pixel);
9531 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->border_pixel);
9532 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->mouse_pixel);
9533
9534 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel != -1)
9535 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_background_pixel);
9536 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel != -1)
9537 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_foreground_pixel);
9538 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
9539 /* Scrollbar shadow colors. */
9540 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel != -1)
9541 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_top_shadow_pixel);
9542 if (f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel != -1)
9543 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->scroll_bar_bottom_shadow_pixel);
9544 #endif /* USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS */
9545 if (f->output_data.x->white_relief.allocated_p)
9546 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->white_relief.pixel);
9547 if (f->output_data.x->black_relief.allocated_p)
9548 unload_color (f, f->output_data.x->black_relief.pixel);
9549
9550 x_free_gcs (f);
9551 XFlush (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f));
9552 }
9553
9554 xfree (f->output_data.x->saved_menu_event);
9555 xfree (f->output_data.x);
9556 f->output_data.x = NULL;
9557
9558 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_frame)
9559 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
9560 if (f == dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame)
9561 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
9562 if (f == dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame)
9563 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
9564
9565 if (f == hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame)
9566 {
9567 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row
9568 = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
9569 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row
9570 = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
9571 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
9572 hlinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
9573 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
9574 }
9575
9576 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
9577 }
9578
9579
9580 /* Destroy the X window of frame F. */
9581
9582 static void
9583 x_destroy_window (struct frame *f)
9584 {
9585 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f);
9586
9587 /* If a display connection is dead, don't try sending more
9588 commands to the X server. */
9589 if (dpyinfo->display != 0)
9590 x_free_frame_resources (f);
9591
9592 dpyinfo->reference_count--;
9593 }
9594
9595 \f
9596 /* Setting window manager hints. */
9597
9598 /* Set the normal size hints for the window manager, for frame F.
9599 FLAGS is the flags word to use--or 0 meaning preserve the flags
9600 that the window now has.
9601 If USER_POSITION is nonzero, we set the USPosition
9602 flag (this is useful when FLAGS is 0).
9603 The GTK version is in gtkutils.c */
9604
9605 #ifndef USE_GTK
9606 void
9607 x_wm_set_size_hint (struct frame *f, long flags, int user_position)
9608 {
9609 XSizeHints size_hints;
9610 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9611
9612 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9613 if (f->output_data.x->widget)
9614 {
9615 widget_update_wm_size_hints (f->output_data.x->widget);
9616 return;
9617 }
9618 #endif
9619
9620 /* Setting PMaxSize caused various problems. */
9621 size_hints.flags = PResizeInc | PMinSize /* | PMaxSize */;
9622
9623 size_hints.x = f->left_pos;
9624 size_hints.y = f->top_pos;
9625
9626 size_hints.height = FRAME_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f);
9627 size_hints.width = FRAME_PIXEL_WIDTH (f);
9628
9629 size_hints.width_inc = FRAME_COLUMN_WIDTH (f);
9630 size_hints.height_inc = FRAME_LINE_HEIGHT (f);
9631 size_hints.max_width = x_display_pixel_width (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
9632 - FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9633 size_hints.max_height = x_display_pixel_height (FRAME_X_DISPLAY_INFO (f))
9634 - FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9635
9636 /* Calculate the base and minimum sizes. */
9637 {
9638 int base_width, base_height;
9639 int min_rows = 0, min_cols = 0;
9640
9641 base_width = FRAME_TEXT_COLS_TO_PIXEL_WIDTH (f, 0);
9642 base_height = FRAME_TEXT_LINES_TO_PIXEL_HEIGHT (f, 0);
9643
9644 check_frame_size (f, &min_rows, &min_cols);
9645
9646 /* The window manager uses the base width hints to calculate the
9647 current number of rows and columns in the frame while
9648 resizing; min_width and min_height aren't useful for this
9649 purpose, since they might not give the dimensions for a
9650 zero-row, zero-column frame.
9651
9652 We use the base_width and base_height members if we have
9653 them; otherwise, we set the min_width and min_height members
9654 to the size for a zero x zero frame. */
9655
9656 size_hints.flags |= PBaseSize;
9657 size_hints.base_width = base_width;
9658 size_hints.base_height = base_height + FRAME_MENUBAR_HEIGHT (f);
9659 size_hints.min_width = base_width + min_cols * size_hints.width_inc;
9660 size_hints.min_height = base_height + min_rows * size_hints.height_inc;
9661 }
9662
9663 /* If we don't need the old flags, we don't need the old hint at all. */
9664 if (flags)
9665 {
9666 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9667 goto no_read;
9668 }
9669
9670 {
9671 XSizeHints hints; /* Sometimes I hate X Windows... */
9672 long supplied_return;
9673 int value;
9674
9675 value = XGetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &hints,
9676 &supplied_return);
9677
9678 if (flags)
9679 size_hints.flags |= flags;
9680 else
9681 {
9682 if (value == 0)
9683 hints.flags = 0;
9684 if (hints.flags & PSize)
9685 size_hints.flags |= PSize;
9686 if (hints.flags & PPosition)
9687 size_hints.flags |= PPosition;
9688 if (hints.flags & USPosition)
9689 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9690 if (hints.flags & USSize)
9691 size_hints.flags |= USSize;
9692 }
9693 }
9694
9695 no_read:
9696
9697 #ifdef PWinGravity
9698 size_hints.win_gravity = f->win_gravity;
9699 size_hints.flags |= PWinGravity;
9700
9701 if (user_position)
9702 {
9703 size_hints.flags &= ~ PPosition;
9704 size_hints.flags |= USPosition;
9705 }
9706 #endif /* PWinGravity */
9707
9708 XSetWMNormalHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &size_hints);
9709 }
9710 #endif /* not USE_GTK */
9711
9712 /* Used for IconicState or NormalState */
9713
9714 static void
9715 x_wm_set_window_state (struct frame *f, int state)
9716 {
9717 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9718 Arg al[1];
9719
9720 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNinitialState, state);
9721 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9722 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9723 Window window = FRAME_X_WINDOW (f);
9724
9725 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= StateHint;
9726 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.initial_state = state;
9727
9728 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9729 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9730 }
9731
9732 static void
9733 x_wm_set_icon_pixmap (struct frame *f, ptrdiff_t pixmap_id)
9734 {
9735 Pixmap icon_pixmap, icon_mask;
9736
9737 #if !defined USE_X_TOOLKIT && !defined USE_GTK
9738 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9739 #endif
9740
9741 if (pixmap_id > 0)
9742 {
9743 icon_pixmap = x_bitmap_pixmap (f, pixmap_id);
9744 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_pixmap = icon_pixmap;
9745 icon_mask = x_bitmap_mask (f, pixmap_id);
9746 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_mask = icon_mask;
9747 }
9748 else
9749 {
9750 /* It seems there is no way to turn off use of an icon
9751 pixmap. */
9752 return;
9753 }
9754
9755
9756 #ifdef USE_GTK
9757 {
9758 xg_set_frame_icon (f, icon_pixmap, icon_mask);
9759 return;
9760 }
9761
9762 #elif defined (USE_X_TOOLKIT) /* same as in x_wm_set_window_state. */
9763
9764 {
9765 Arg al[1];
9766 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconPixmap, icon_pixmap);
9767 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9768 XtSetArg (al[0], XtNiconMask, icon_mask);
9769 XtSetValues (f->output_data.x->widget, al, 1);
9770 }
9771
9772 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
9773
9774 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= (IconPixmapHint | IconMaskHint);
9775 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9776
9777 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT && not USE_GTK */
9778 }
9779
9780 void
9781 x_wm_set_icon_position (struct frame *f, int icon_x, int icon_y)
9782 {
9783 Window window = FRAME_OUTER_WINDOW (f);
9784
9785 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.flags |= IconPositionHint;
9786 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_x = icon_x;
9787 f->output_data.x->wm_hints.icon_y = icon_y;
9788
9789 XSetWMHints (FRAME_X_DISPLAY (f), window, &f->output_data.x->wm_hints);
9790 }
9791
9792 \f
9793 /***********************************************************************
9794 Fonts
9795 ***********************************************************************/
9796
9797 #ifdef GLYPH_DEBUG
9798
9799 /* Check that FONT is valid on frame F. It is if it can be found in F's
9800 font table. */
9801
9802 static void
9803 x_check_font (struct frame *f, struct font *font)
9804 {
9805 eassert (font != NULL && ! NILP (font->props[FONT_TYPE_INDEX]));
9806 if (font->driver->check)
9807 eassert (font->driver->check (f, font) == 0);
9808 }
9809
9810 #endif /* GLYPH_DEBUG */
9811
9812 \f
9813 /***********************************************************************
9814 Initialization
9815 ***********************************************************************/
9816
9817 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
9818 static XrmOptionDescRec emacs_options[] = {
9819 {"-geometry", ".geometry", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9820 {"-iconic", ".iconic", XrmoptionNoArg, (XtPointer) "yes"},
9821
9822 {"-internal-border-width", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth",
9823 XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9824 {"-ib", "*EmacsScreen.internalBorderWidth", XrmoptionSepArg, NULL},
9825
9826 {"-T", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9827 {"-wn", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9828 {"-title", "*EmacsShell.title", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9829 {"-iconname", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9830 {"-in", "*EmacsShell.iconName", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9831 {"-mc", "*pointerColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL},
9832 {"-cr", "*cursorColor", XrmoptionSepArg, (XtPointer) NULL}
9833 };
9834
9835 /* Whether atimer for Xt timeouts is activated or not. */
9836
9837 static int x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag;
9838
9839 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
9840
9841 static int x_initialized;
9842
9843 /* Test whether two display-name strings agree up to the dot that separates
9844 the screen number from the server number. */
9845 static int
9846 same_x_server (const char *name1, const char *name2)
9847 {
9848 int seen_colon = 0;
9849 const char *system_name = SSDATA (Vsystem_name);
9850 ptrdiff_t system_name_length = SBYTES (Vsystem_name);
9851 ptrdiff_t length_until_period = 0;
9852
9853 while (system_name[length_until_period] != 0
9854 && system_name[length_until_period] != '.')
9855 length_until_period++;
9856
9857 /* Treat `unix' like an empty host name. */
9858 if (! strncmp (name1, "unix:", 5))
9859 name1 += 4;
9860 if (! strncmp (name2, "unix:", 5))
9861 name2 += 4;
9862 /* Treat this host's name like an empty host name. */
9863 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, system_name_length)
9864 && name1[system_name_length] == ':')
9865 name1 += system_name_length;
9866 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, system_name_length)
9867 && name2[system_name_length] == ':')
9868 name2 += system_name_length;
9869 /* Treat this host's domainless name like an empty host name. */
9870 if (! strncmp (name1, system_name, length_until_period)
9871 && name1[length_until_period] == ':')
9872 name1 += length_until_period;
9873 if (! strncmp (name2, system_name, length_until_period)
9874 && name2[length_until_period] == ':')
9875 name2 += length_until_period;
9876
9877 for (; *name1 != '\0' && *name1 == *name2; name1++, name2++)
9878 {
9879 if (*name1 == ':')
9880 seen_colon = 1;
9881 if (seen_colon && *name1 == '.')
9882 return 1;
9883 }
9884 return (seen_colon
9885 && (*name1 == '.' || *name1 == '\0')
9886 && (*name2 == '.' || *name2 == '\0'));
9887 }
9888
9889 /* Count number of set bits in mask and number of bits to shift to
9890 get to the first bit. With MASK 0x7e0, *BITS is set to 6, and *OFFSET
9891 to 5. */
9892 static void
9893 get_bits_and_offset (long unsigned int mask, int *bits, int *offset)
9894 {
9895 int nr = 0;
9896 int off = 0;
9897
9898 while (!(mask & 1))
9899 {
9900 off++;
9901 mask >>= 1;
9902 }
9903
9904 while (mask & 1)
9905 {
9906 nr++;
9907 mask >>= 1;
9908 }
9909
9910 *offset = off;
9911 *bits = nr;
9912 }
9913
9914 /* Return 1 if display DISPLAY is available for use, 0 otherwise.
9915 But don't permanently open it, just test its availability. */
9916
9917 int
9918 x_display_ok (const char *display)
9919 {
9920 int dpy_ok = 1;
9921 Display *dpy;
9922
9923 dpy = XOpenDisplay (display);
9924 if (dpy)
9925 XCloseDisplay (dpy);
9926 else
9927 dpy_ok = 0;
9928 return dpy_ok;
9929 }
9930
9931 #ifdef USE_GTK
9932 static void
9933 my_log_handler (const gchar *log_domain, GLogLevelFlags log_level,
9934 const gchar *msg, gpointer user_data)
9935 {
9936 if (!strstr (msg, "g_set_prgname"))
9937 fprintf (stderr, "%s-WARNING **: %s\n", log_domain, msg);
9938 }
9939 #endif
9940
9941 /* Open a connection to X display DISPLAY_NAME, and return
9942 the structure that describes the open display.
9943 If we cannot contact the display, return null. */
9944
9945 struct x_display_info *
9946 x_term_init (Lisp_Object display_name, char *xrm_option, char *resource_name)
9947 {
9948 int connection;
9949 Display *dpy;
9950 struct terminal *terminal;
9951 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo;
9952 XrmDatabase xrdb;
9953 Mouse_HLInfo *hlinfo;
9954 ptrdiff_t lim;
9955
9956 BLOCK_INPUT;
9957
9958 if (!x_initialized)
9959 {
9960 x_initialize ();
9961 ++x_initialized;
9962 }
9963
9964 if (! x_display_ok (SSDATA (display_name)))
9965 error ("Display %s can't be opened", SSDATA (display_name));
9966
9967 #ifdef USE_GTK
9968 {
9969 #define NUM_ARGV 10
9970 int argc;
9971 char *argv[NUM_ARGV];
9972 char **argv2 = argv;
9973 guint id;
9974
9975 if (x_initialized++ > 1)
9976 {
9977 xg_display_open (SSDATA (display_name), &dpy);
9978 }
9979 else
9980 {
9981 static char display_opt[] = "--display";
9982 static char name_opt[] = "--name";
9983
9984 for (argc = 0; argc < NUM_ARGV; ++argc)
9985 argv[argc] = 0;
9986
9987 argc = 0;
9988 argv[argc++] = initial_argv[0];
9989
9990 if (! NILP (display_name))
9991 {
9992 argv[argc++] = display_opt;
9993 argv[argc++] = SSDATA (display_name);
9994 }
9995
9996 argv[argc++] = name_opt;
9997 argv[argc++] = resource_name;
9998
9999 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
10000
10001 /* Emacs can only handle core input events, so make sure
10002 Gtk doesn't use Xinput or Xinput2 extensions. */
10003 {
10004 static char fix_events[] = "GDK_CORE_DEVICE_EVENTS=1";
10005 putenv (fix_events);
10006 }
10007
10008 /* Work around GLib bug that outputs a faulty warning. See
10009 https://bugzilla.gnome.org/show_bug.cgi?id=563627. */
10010 id = g_log_set_handler ("GLib", G_LOG_LEVEL_WARNING | G_LOG_FLAG_FATAL
10011 | G_LOG_FLAG_RECURSION, my_log_handler, NULL);
10012
10013 /* NULL window -> events for all windows go to our function.
10014 Call before gtk_init so Gtk+ event filters comes after our. */
10015 gdk_window_add_filter (NULL, event_handler_gdk, NULL);
10016
10017 gtk_init (&argc, &argv2);
10018 g_log_remove_handler ("GLib", id);
10019
10020 /* gtk_init does set_locale. We must fix locale after calling it. */
10021 fixup_locale ();
10022 xg_initialize ();
10023
10024 dpy = DEFAULT_GDK_DISPLAY ();
10025
10026 #if GTK_MAJOR_VERSION <= 2 && GTK_MINOR_VERSION <= 90
10027 /* Load our own gtkrc if it exists. */
10028 {
10029 const char *file = "~/.emacs.d/gtkrc";
10030 Lisp_Object s, abs_file;
10031
10032 s = build_string (file);
10033 abs_file = Fexpand_file_name (s, Qnil);
10034
10035 if (! NILP (abs_file) && !NILP (Ffile_readable_p (abs_file)))
10036 gtk_rc_parse (SSDATA (abs_file));
10037 }
10038 #endif
10039
10040 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
10041 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
10042 }
10043 }
10044 #else /* not USE_GTK */
10045 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10046 /* weiner@footloose.sps.mot.com reports that this causes
10047 errors with X11R5:
10048 X protocol error: BadAtom (invalid Atom parameter)
10049 on protocol request 18skiloaf.
10050 So let's not use it until R6. */
10051 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
10052 XtSetLanguageProc (NULL, NULL, NULL);
10053 #endif
10054
10055 {
10056 int argc = 0;
10057 char *argv[3];
10058
10059 argv[0] = "";
10060 argc = 1;
10061 if (xrm_option)
10062 {
10063 argv[argc++] = "-xrm";
10064 argv[argc++] = xrm_option;
10065 }
10066 turn_on_atimers (0);
10067 dpy = XtOpenDisplay (Xt_app_con, SSDATA (display_name),
10068 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS,
10069 emacs_options, XtNumber (emacs_options),
10070 &argc, argv);
10071 turn_on_atimers (1);
10072
10073 #ifdef HAVE_X11XTR6
10074 /* I think this is to compensate for XtSetLanguageProc. */
10075 fixup_locale ();
10076 #endif
10077 }
10078
10079 #else /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10080 XSetLocaleModifiers ("");
10081 dpy = XOpenDisplay (SSDATA (display_name));
10082 #endif /* not USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10083 #endif /* not USE_GTK*/
10084
10085 /* Detect failure. */
10086 if (dpy == 0)
10087 {
10088 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10089 return 0;
10090 }
10091
10092 /* We have definitely succeeded. Record the new connection. */
10093
10094 dpyinfo = xzalloc (sizeof *dpyinfo);
10095 hlinfo = &dpyinfo->mouse_highlight;
10096
10097 terminal = x_create_terminal (dpyinfo);
10098
10099 {
10100 struct x_display_info *share;
10101 Lisp_Object tail;
10102
10103 for (share = x_display_list, tail = x_display_name_list; share;
10104 share = share->next, tail = XCDR (tail))
10105 if (same_x_server (SSDATA (XCAR (XCAR (tail))),
10106 SSDATA (display_name)))
10107 break;
10108 if (share)
10109 terminal->kboard = share->terminal->kboard;
10110 else
10111 {
10112 terminal->kboard = xmalloc (sizeof *terminal->kboard);
10113 init_kboard (terminal->kboard);
10114 kset_window_system (terminal->kboard, Qx);
10115
10116 /* Add the keyboard to the list before running Lisp code (via
10117 Qvendor_specific_keysyms below), since these are not traced
10118 via terminals but only through all_kboards. */
10119 terminal->kboard->next_kboard = all_kboards;
10120 all_kboards = terminal->kboard;
10121
10122 if (!EQ (XSYMBOL (Qvendor_specific_keysyms)->function, Qunbound))
10123 {
10124 char *vendor = ServerVendor (dpy);
10125
10126 /* Protect terminal from GC before removing it from the
10127 list of terminals. */
10128 struct gcpro gcpro1;
10129 Lisp_Object gcpro_term;
10130 XSETTERMINAL (gcpro_term, terminal);
10131 GCPRO1 (gcpro_term);
10132
10133 /* Temporarily hide the partially initialized terminal. */
10134 terminal_list = terminal->next_terminal;
10135 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10136 kset_system_key_alist
10137 (terminal->kboard,
10138 call1 (Qvendor_specific_keysyms,
10139 vendor ? build_string (vendor) : empty_unibyte_string));
10140 BLOCK_INPUT;
10141 terminal->next_terminal = terminal_list;
10142 terminal_list = terminal;
10143 UNGCPRO;
10144 }
10145
10146 /* Don't let the initial kboard remain current longer than necessary.
10147 That would cause problems if a file loaded on startup tries to
10148 prompt in the mini-buffer. */
10149 if (current_kboard == initial_kboard)
10150 current_kboard = terminal->kboard;
10151 }
10152 terminal->kboard->reference_count++;
10153 }
10154
10155 /* Put this display on the chain. */
10156 dpyinfo->next = x_display_list;
10157 x_display_list = dpyinfo;
10158
10159 /* Put it on x_display_name_list as well, to keep them parallel. */
10160 x_display_name_list = Fcons (Fcons (display_name, Qnil),
10161 x_display_name_list);
10162 dpyinfo->name_list_element = XCAR (x_display_name_list);
10163
10164 dpyinfo->display = dpy;
10165
10166 /* Set the name of the terminal. */
10167 terminal->name = xmalloc (SBYTES (display_name) + 1);
10168 memcpy (terminal->name, SSDATA (display_name), SBYTES (display_name));
10169 terminal->name[SBYTES (display_name)] = 0;
10170
10171 #if 0
10172 XSetAfterFunction (x_current_display, x_trace_wire);
10173 #endif /* ! 0 */
10174
10175 lim = min (PTRDIFF_MAX, SIZE_MAX) - sizeof "@";
10176 if (lim - SBYTES (Vinvocation_name) < SBYTES (Vsystem_name))
10177 memory_full (SIZE_MAX);
10178 dpyinfo->x_id_name = xmalloc (SBYTES (Vinvocation_name)
10179 + SBYTES (Vsystem_name) + 2);
10180 strcat (strcat (strcpy (dpyinfo->x_id_name, SSDATA (Vinvocation_name)), "@"),
10181 SSDATA (Vsystem_name));
10182
10183 /* Figure out which modifier bits mean what. */
10184 x_find_modifier_meanings (dpyinfo);
10185
10186 /* Get the scroll bar cursor. */
10187 #ifdef USE_GTK
10188 /* We must create a GTK cursor, it is required for GTK widgets. */
10189 dpyinfo->xg_cursor = xg_create_default_cursor (dpyinfo->display);
10190 #endif /* USE_GTK */
10191
10192 dpyinfo->vertical_scroll_bar_cursor
10193 = XCreateFontCursor (dpyinfo->display, XC_sb_v_double_arrow);
10194
10195 xrdb = x_load_resources (dpyinfo->display, xrm_option,
10196 resource_name, EMACS_CLASS);
10197 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
10198 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo->display, xrdb);
10199 #else
10200 dpyinfo->display->db = xrdb;
10201 #endif
10202 /* Put the rdb where we can find it in a way that works on
10203 all versions. */
10204 dpyinfo->xrdb = xrdb;
10205
10206 dpyinfo->screen = ScreenOfDisplay (dpyinfo->display,
10207 DefaultScreen (dpyinfo->display));
10208 select_visual (dpyinfo);
10209 dpyinfo->cmap = DefaultColormapOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10210 dpyinfo->root_window = RootWindowOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10211 dpyinfo->client_leader_window = 0;
10212 dpyinfo->grabbed = 0;
10213 dpyinfo->reference_count = 0;
10214 dpyinfo->icon_bitmap_id = -1;
10215 dpyinfo->n_fonts = 0;
10216 dpyinfo->bitmaps = 0;
10217 dpyinfo->bitmaps_size = 0;
10218 dpyinfo->bitmaps_last = 0;
10219 dpyinfo->scratch_cursor_gc = 0;
10220 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_frame = 0;
10221 hlinfo->mouse_face_deferred_gc = 0;
10222 hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_beg_col = -1;
10223 hlinfo->mouse_face_end_row = hlinfo->mouse_face_end_col = -1;
10224 hlinfo->mouse_face_face_id = DEFAULT_FACE_ID;
10225 hlinfo->mouse_face_window = Qnil;
10226 hlinfo->mouse_face_overlay = Qnil;
10227 hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_x = hlinfo->mouse_face_mouse_y = 0;
10228 hlinfo->mouse_face_defer = 0;
10229 hlinfo->mouse_face_hidden = 0;
10230 dpyinfo->x_focus_frame = 0;
10231 dpyinfo->x_focus_event_frame = 0;
10232 dpyinfo->x_highlight_frame = 0;
10233 dpyinfo->wm_type = X_WMTYPE_UNKNOWN;
10234
10235 /* See if we can construct pixel values from RGB values. */
10236 dpyinfo->red_bits = dpyinfo->blue_bits = dpyinfo->green_bits = 0;
10237 dpyinfo->red_offset = dpyinfo->blue_offset = dpyinfo->green_offset = 0;
10238
10239 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == TrueColor)
10240 {
10241 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->red_mask,
10242 &dpyinfo->red_bits, &dpyinfo->red_offset);
10243 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->blue_mask,
10244 &dpyinfo->blue_bits, &dpyinfo->blue_offset);
10245 get_bits_and_offset (dpyinfo->visual->green_mask,
10246 &dpyinfo->green_bits, &dpyinfo->green_offset);
10247 }
10248
10249 /* See if a private colormap is requested. */
10250 if (dpyinfo->visual == DefaultVisualOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen))
10251 {
10252 if (dpyinfo->visual->class == PseudoColor)
10253 {
10254 Lisp_Object value;
10255 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10256 build_string ("privateColormap"),
10257 build_string ("PrivateColormap"),
10258 Qnil, Qnil);
10259 if (STRINGP (value)
10260 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "true")
10261 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "on")))
10262 dpyinfo->cmap = XCopyColormapAndFree (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->cmap);
10263 }
10264 }
10265 else
10266 dpyinfo->cmap = XCreateColormap (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10267 dpyinfo->visual, AllocNone);
10268
10269 #ifdef HAVE_XFT
10270 {
10271 /* If we are using Xft, check dpi value in X resources.
10272 It is better we use it as well, since Xft will use it, as will all
10273 Gnome applications. If our real DPI is smaller or larger than the
10274 one Xft uses, our font will look smaller or larger than other
10275 for other applications, even if it is the same font name (monospace-10
10276 for example). */
10277 char *v = XGetDefault (dpyinfo->display, "Xft", "dpi");
10278 double d;
10279 if (v != NULL && sscanf (v, "%lf", &d) == 1)
10280 dpyinfo->resy = dpyinfo->resx = d;
10281 }
10282 #endif
10283
10284 if (dpyinfo->resy < 1)
10285 {
10286 int screen_number = XScreenNumberOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen);
10287 double pixels = DisplayHeight (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10288 double mm = DisplayHeightMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10289 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10290 dpyinfo->resy = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10291 pixels = DisplayWidth (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10292 mm = DisplayWidthMM (dpyinfo->display, screen_number);
10293 /* Mac OS X 10.3's Xserver sometimes reports 0.0mm. */
10294 dpyinfo->resx = (mm < 1) ? 100 : pixels * 25.4 / mm;
10295 }
10296
10297 {
10298 const struct
10299 {
10300 const char *name;
10301 Atom *atom;
10302 } atom_refs[] = {
10303 { "WM_PROTOCOLS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_protocols },
10304 { "WM_TAKE_FOCUS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_take_focus },
10305 { "WM_SAVE_YOURSELF", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_save_yourself },
10306 { "WM_DELETE_WINDOW", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_delete_window },
10307 { "WM_CHANGE_STATE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_change_state },
10308 { "WM_CONFIGURE_DENIED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_configure_denied },
10309 { "WM_MOVED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_window_moved },
10310 { "WM_CLIENT_LEADER", &dpyinfo->Xatom_wm_client_leader },
10311 { "Editres", &dpyinfo->Xatom_editres },
10312 { "CLIPBOARD", &dpyinfo->Xatom_CLIPBOARD },
10313 { "TIMESTAMP", &dpyinfo->Xatom_TIMESTAMP },
10314 { "TEXT", &dpyinfo->Xatom_TEXT },
10315 { "COMPOUND_TEXT", &dpyinfo->Xatom_COMPOUND_TEXT },
10316 { "UTF8_STRING", &dpyinfo->Xatom_UTF8_STRING },
10317 { "DELETE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_DELETE },
10318 { "MULTIPLE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULTIPLE },
10319 { "INCR", &dpyinfo->Xatom_INCR },
10320 { "_EMACS_TMP_", &dpyinfo->Xatom_EMACS_TMP },
10321 { "TARGETS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_TARGETS },
10322 { "NULL", &dpyinfo->Xatom_NULL },
10323 { "ATOM", &dpyinfo->Xatom_ATOM },
10324 { "ATOM_PAIR", &dpyinfo->Xatom_ATOM_PAIR },
10325 { "CLIPBOARD_MANAGER", &dpyinfo->Xatom_CLIPBOARD_MANAGER },
10326 { "_XEMBED_INFO", &dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED_INFO },
10327 /* For properties of font. */
10328 { "PIXEL_SIZE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_PIXEL_SIZE },
10329 { "AVERAGE_WIDTH", &dpyinfo->Xatom_AVERAGE_WIDTH },
10330 { "_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_BASELINE_OFFSET },
10331 { "_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_RELATIVE_COMPOSE },
10332 { "_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT", &dpyinfo->Xatom_MULE_DEFAULT_ASCENT },
10333 /* Ghostscript support. */
10334 { "DONE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_DONE },
10335 { "PAGE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_PAGE },
10336 { "SCROLLBAR", &dpyinfo->Xatom_Scrollbar },
10337 { "_XEMBED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_XEMBED },
10338 /* EWMH */
10339 { "_NET_WM_STATE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state },
10340 { "_NET_WM_STATE_FULLSCREEN", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_fullscreen },
10341 { "_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_HORZ",
10342 &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_horz },
10343 { "_NET_WM_STATE_MAXIMIZED_VERT",
10344 &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_maximized_vert },
10345 { "_NET_WM_STATE_STICKY", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_sticky },
10346 { "_NET_WM_STATE_HIDDEN", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_state_hidden },
10347 { "_NET_WM_WINDOW_TYPE", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_window_type },
10348 { "_NET_WM_WINDOW_TYPE_TOOLTIP",
10349 &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_window_type_tooltip },
10350 { "_NET_WM_ICON_NAME", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_icon_name },
10351 { "_NET_WM_NAME", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_name },
10352 { "_NET_SUPPORTED", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supported },
10353 { "_NET_SUPPORTING_WM_CHECK", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_supporting_wm_check },
10354 { "_NET_WM_WINDOW_OPACITY", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_wm_window_opacity },
10355 { "_NET_ACTIVE_WINDOW", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_active_window },
10356 { "_NET_FRAME_EXTENTS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_net_frame_extents },
10357 /* Session management */
10358 { "SM_CLIENT_ID", &dpyinfo->Xatom_SM_CLIENT_ID },
10359 { "_XSETTINGS_SETTINGS", &dpyinfo->Xatom_xsettings_prop },
10360 { "MANAGER", &dpyinfo->Xatom_xsettings_mgr },
10361 };
10362
10363 int i;
10364 const int atom_count = sizeof (atom_refs) / sizeof (atom_refs[0]);
10365 /* 1 for _XSETTINGS_SN */
10366 const int total_atom_count = 1 + atom_count;
10367 Atom *atoms_return = xmalloc (total_atom_count * sizeof *atoms_return);
10368 char **atom_names = xmalloc (total_atom_count * sizeof *atom_names);
10369 static char const xsettings_fmt[] = "_XSETTINGS_S%d";
10370 char xsettings_atom_name[sizeof xsettings_fmt - 2
10371 + INT_STRLEN_BOUND (int)];
10372
10373 for (i = 0; i < atom_count; i++)
10374 atom_names[i] = (char *) atom_refs[i].name;
10375
10376 /* Build _XSETTINGS_SN atom name */
10377 sprintf (xsettings_atom_name, xsettings_fmt,
10378 XScreenNumberOfScreen (dpyinfo->screen));
10379 atom_names[i] = xsettings_atom_name;
10380
10381 XInternAtoms (dpyinfo->display, atom_names, total_atom_count,
10382 False, atoms_return);
10383
10384 for (i = 0; i < atom_count; i++)
10385 *atom_refs[i].atom = atoms_return[i];
10386
10387 /* Manual copy of last atom */
10388 dpyinfo->Xatom_xsettings_sel = atoms_return[i];
10389
10390 xfree (atom_names);
10391 xfree (atoms_return);
10392 }
10393
10394 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_size = 8;
10395 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_length = 0;
10396 dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms = xmalloc (sizeof *dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms
10397 * dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms_size);
10398
10399 dpyinfo->net_supported_atoms = NULL;
10400 dpyinfo->nr_net_supported_atoms = 0;
10401 dpyinfo->net_supported_window = 0;
10402
10403 connection = ConnectionNumber (dpyinfo->display);
10404 dpyinfo->connection = connection;
10405 dpyinfo->gray
10406 = XCreatePixmapFromBitmapData (dpyinfo->display, dpyinfo->root_window,
10407 gray_bits, gray_width, gray_height,
10408 1, 0, 1);
10409
10410 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10411 xim_initialize (dpyinfo, resource_name);
10412 #endif
10413
10414 xsettings_initialize (dpyinfo);
10415
10416 /* This is only needed for distinguishing keyboard and process input. */
10417 if (connection != 0)
10418 add_keyboard_wait_descriptor (connection);
10419
10420 #ifdef F_SETOWN
10421 fcntl (connection, F_SETOWN, getpid ());
10422 #endif /* ! defined (F_SETOWN) */
10423
10424 #ifdef SIGIO
10425 if (interrupt_input)
10426 init_sigio (connection);
10427 #endif /* ! defined (SIGIO) */
10428
10429 #ifdef USE_LUCID
10430 {
10431 XrmValue d, fr, to;
10432 Font font;
10433
10434 dpy = dpyinfo->display;
10435 d.addr = (XPointer)&dpy;
10436 d.size = sizeof (Display *);
10437 fr.addr = XtDefaultFont;
10438 fr.size = sizeof (XtDefaultFont);
10439 to.size = sizeof (Font *);
10440 to.addr = (XPointer)&font;
10441 x_catch_errors (dpy);
10442 if (!XtCallConverter (dpy, XtCvtStringToFont, &d, 1, &fr, &to, NULL))
10443 emacs_abort ();
10444 if (x_had_errors_p (dpy) || !XQueryFont (dpy, font))
10445 XrmPutLineResource (&xrdb, "Emacs.dialog.*.font: 9x15");
10446 x_uncatch_errors ();
10447 }
10448 #endif
10449
10450 /* See if we should run in synchronous mode. This is useful
10451 for debugging X code. */
10452 {
10453 Lisp_Object value;
10454 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10455 build_string ("synchronous"),
10456 build_string ("Synchronous"),
10457 Qnil, Qnil);
10458 if (STRINGP (value)
10459 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "true")
10460 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "on")))
10461 XSynchronize (dpyinfo->display, True);
10462 }
10463
10464 {
10465 Lisp_Object value;
10466 value = display_x_get_resource (dpyinfo,
10467 build_string ("useXIM"),
10468 build_string ("UseXIM"),
10469 Qnil, Qnil);
10470 #ifdef USE_XIM
10471 if (STRINGP (value)
10472 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "false")
10473 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "off")))
10474 use_xim = 0;
10475 #else
10476 if (STRINGP (value)
10477 && (!strcmp (SSDATA (value), "true")
10478 || !strcmp (SSDATA (value), "on")))
10479 use_xim = 1;
10480 #endif
10481 }
10482
10483 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10484 /* Only do this for the very first display in the Emacs session.
10485 Ignore X session management when Emacs was first started on a
10486 tty. */
10487 if (terminal->id == 1)
10488 x_session_initialize (dpyinfo);
10489 #endif
10490
10491 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10492
10493 return dpyinfo;
10494 }
10495 \f
10496 /* Get rid of display DPYINFO, deleting all frames on it,
10497 and without sending any more commands to the X server. */
10498
10499 static void
10500 x_delete_display (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
10501 {
10502 struct terminal *t;
10503
10504 /* Close all frames and delete the generic struct terminal for this
10505 X display. */
10506 for (t = terminal_list; t; t = t->next_terminal)
10507 if (t->type == output_x_window && t->display_info.x == dpyinfo)
10508 {
10509 #ifdef HAVE_X_SM
10510 /* Close X session management when we close its display. */
10511 if (t->id == 1 && x_session_have_connection ())
10512 x_session_close ();
10513 #endif
10514 delete_terminal (t);
10515 break;
10516 }
10517
10518 delete_keyboard_wait_descriptor (dpyinfo->connection);
10519
10520 /* Discard this display from x_display_name_list and x_display_list.
10521 We can't use Fdelq because that can quit. */
10522 if (! NILP (x_display_name_list)
10523 && EQ (XCAR (x_display_name_list), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
10524 x_display_name_list = XCDR (x_display_name_list);
10525 else
10526 {
10527 Lisp_Object tail;
10528
10529 tail = x_display_name_list;
10530 while (CONSP (tail) && CONSP (XCDR (tail)))
10531 {
10532 if (EQ (XCAR (XCDR (tail)), dpyinfo->name_list_element))
10533 {
10534 XSETCDR (tail, XCDR (XCDR (tail)));
10535 break;
10536 }
10537 tail = XCDR (tail);
10538 }
10539 }
10540
10541 if (next_noop_dpyinfo == dpyinfo)
10542 next_noop_dpyinfo = dpyinfo->next;
10543
10544 if (x_display_list == dpyinfo)
10545 x_display_list = dpyinfo->next;
10546 else
10547 {
10548 struct x_display_info *tail;
10549
10550 for (tail = x_display_list; tail; tail = tail->next)
10551 if (tail->next == dpyinfo)
10552 tail->next = tail->next->next;
10553 }
10554
10555 xfree (dpyinfo->x_id_name);
10556 xfree (dpyinfo->x_dnd_atoms);
10557 xfree (dpyinfo->color_cells);
10558 xfree (dpyinfo);
10559 }
10560
10561 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10562
10563 /* Atimer callback function for TIMER. Called every 0.1s to process
10564 Xt timeouts, if needed. We must avoid calling XtAppPending as
10565 much as possible because that function does an implicit XFlush
10566 that slows us down. */
10567
10568 static void
10569 x_process_timeouts (struct atimer *timer)
10570 {
10571 BLOCK_INPUT;
10572 x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag = 0;
10573 if (toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction || popup_activated ())
10574 {
10575 while (XtAppPending (Xt_app_con) & XtIMTimer)
10576 XtAppProcessEvent (Xt_app_con, XtIMTimer);
10577 /* Reactivate the atimer for next time. */
10578 x_activate_timeout_atimer ();
10579 }
10580 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10581 }
10582
10583 /* Install an asynchronous timer that processes Xt timeout events
10584 every 0.1s as long as either `toolkit_scroll_bar_interaction' or
10585 `popup_activated_flag' (in xmenu.c) is set. Make sure to call this
10586 function whenever these variables are set. This is necessary
10587 because some widget sets use timeouts internally, for example the
10588 LessTif menu bar, or the Xaw3d scroll bar. When Xt timeouts aren't
10589 processed, these widgets don't behave normally. */
10590
10591 void
10592 x_activate_timeout_atimer (void)
10593 {
10594 BLOCK_INPUT;
10595 if (!x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag)
10596 {
10597 EMACS_TIME interval = make_emacs_time (0, 100 * 1000 * 1000);
10598 start_atimer (ATIMER_RELATIVE, interval, x_process_timeouts, 0);
10599 x_timeout_atimer_activated_flag = 1;
10600 }
10601 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10602 }
10603
10604 #endif /* USE_X_TOOLKIT */
10605
10606 \f
10607 /* Set up use of X before we make the first connection. */
10608
10609 static struct redisplay_interface x_redisplay_interface =
10610 {
10611 x_frame_parm_handlers,
10612 x_produce_glyphs,
10613 x_write_glyphs,
10614 x_insert_glyphs,
10615 x_clear_end_of_line,
10616 x_scroll_run,
10617 x_after_update_window_line,
10618 x_update_window_begin,
10619 x_update_window_end,
10620 x_cursor_to,
10621 x_flush,
10622 #ifdef XFlush
10623 x_flush,
10624 #else
10625 0, /* flush_display_optional */
10626 #endif
10627 x_clear_window_mouse_face,
10628 x_get_glyph_overhangs,
10629 x_fix_overlapping_area,
10630 x_draw_fringe_bitmap,
10631 0, /* define_fringe_bitmap */
10632 0, /* destroy_fringe_bitmap */
10633 x_compute_glyph_string_overhangs,
10634 x_draw_glyph_string,
10635 x_define_frame_cursor,
10636 x_clear_frame_area,
10637 x_draw_window_cursor,
10638 x_draw_vertical_window_border,
10639 x_shift_glyphs_for_insert
10640 };
10641
10642
10643 /* This function is called when the last frame on a display is deleted. */
10644 void
10645 x_delete_terminal (struct terminal *terminal)
10646 {
10647 struct x_display_info *dpyinfo = terminal->display_info.x;
10648
10649 /* Protect against recursive calls. delete_frame in
10650 delete_terminal calls us back when it deletes our last frame. */
10651 if (!terminal->name)
10652 return;
10653
10654 BLOCK_INPUT;
10655 #ifdef HAVE_X_I18N
10656 /* We must close our connection to the XIM server before closing the
10657 X display. */
10658 if (dpyinfo->xim)
10659 xim_close_dpy (dpyinfo);
10660 #endif
10661
10662 /* If called from x_connection_closed, the display may already be closed
10663 and dpyinfo->display was set to 0 to indicate that. */
10664 if (dpyinfo->display)
10665 {
10666 x_destroy_all_bitmaps (dpyinfo);
10667 XSetCloseDownMode (dpyinfo->display, DestroyAll);
10668
10669 /* Whether or not XCloseDisplay destroys the associated resource
10670 database depends on the version of libX11. To avoid both
10671 crash and memory leak, we dissociate the database from the
10672 display and then destroy dpyinfo->xrdb ourselves.
10673
10674 Unfortunately, the above strategy does not work in some
10675 situations due to a bug in newer versions of libX11: because
10676 XrmSetDatabase doesn't clear the flag XlibDisplayDfltRMDB if
10677 dpy->db is NULL, XCloseDisplay destroys the associated
10678 database whereas it has not been created by XGetDefault
10679 (Bug#21974 in freedesktop.org Bugzilla). As a workaround, we
10680 don't destroy the database here in order to avoid the crash
10681 in the above situations for now, though that may cause memory
10682 leaks in other situations. */
10683 #if 0
10684 #ifdef HAVE_XRMSETDATABASE
10685 XrmSetDatabase (dpyinfo->display, NULL);
10686 #else
10687 dpyinfo->display->db = NULL;
10688 #endif
10689 /* We used to call XrmDestroyDatabase from x_delete_display, but
10690 some older versions of libX11 crash if we call it after
10691 closing all the displays. */
10692 XrmDestroyDatabase (dpyinfo->xrdb);
10693 #endif
10694
10695 #ifdef USE_GTK
10696 xg_display_close (dpyinfo->display);
10697 #else
10698 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10699 XtCloseDisplay (dpyinfo->display);
10700 #else
10701 XCloseDisplay (dpyinfo->display);
10702 #endif
10703 #endif /* ! USE_GTK */
10704 }
10705
10706 /* Mark as dead. */
10707 dpyinfo->display = NULL;
10708 x_delete_display (dpyinfo);
10709 UNBLOCK_INPUT;
10710 }
10711
10712 /* Create a struct terminal, initialize it with the X11 specific
10713 functions and make DISPLAY->TERMINAL point to it. */
10714
10715 static struct terminal *
10716 x_create_terminal (struct x_display_info *dpyinfo)
10717 {
10718 struct terminal *terminal;
10719
10720 terminal = create_terminal ();
10721
10722 terminal->type = output_x_window;
10723 terminal->display_info.x = dpyinfo;
10724 dpyinfo->terminal = terminal;
10725
10726 /* kboard is initialized in x_term_init. */
10727
10728 terminal->clear_frame_hook = x_clear_frame;
10729 terminal->ins_del_lines_hook = x_ins_del_lines;
10730 terminal->delete_glyphs_hook = x_delete_glyphs;
10731 terminal->ring_bell_hook = XTring_bell;
10732 terminal->toggle_invisible_pointer_hook = XTtoggle_invisible_pointer;
10733 terminal->reset_terminal_modes_hook = XTreset_terminal_modes;
10734 terminal->set_terminal_modes_hook = XTset_terminal_modes;
10735 terminal->update_begin_hook = x_update_begin;
10736 terminal->update_end_hook = x_update_end;
10737 terminal->set_terminal_window_hook = XTset_terminal_window;
10738 terminal->read_socket_hook = XTread_socket;
10739 terminal->frame_up_to_date_hook = XTframe_up_to_date;
10740 terminal->mouse_position_hook = XTmouse_position;
10741 terminal->frame_rehighlight_hook = XTframe_rehighlight;
10742 terminal->frame_raise_lower_hook = XTframe_raise_lower;
10743 terminal->fullscreen_hook = XTfullscreen_hook;
10744 terminal->set_vertical_scroll_bar_hook = XTset_vertical_scroll_bar;
10745 terminal->condemn_scroll_bars_hook = XTcondemn_scroll_bars;
10746 terminal->redeem_scroll_bar_hook = XTredeem_scroll_bar;
10747 terminal->judge_scroll_bars_hook = XTjudge_scroll_bars;
10748
10749 terminal->delete_frame_hook = x_destroy_window;
10750 terminal->delete_terminal_hook = x_delete_terminal;
10751
10752 terminal->rif = &x_redisplay_interface;
10753 terminal->scroll_region_ok = 1; /* We'll scroll partial frames. */
10754 terminal->char_ins_del_ok = 1;
10755 terminal->line_ins_del_ok = 1; /* We'll just blt 'em. */
10756 terminal->fast_clear_end_of_line = 1; /* X does this well. */
10757 terminal->memory_below_frame = 0; /* We don't remember what scrolls
10758 off the bottom. */
10759
10760 return terminal;
10761 }
10762
10763 void
10764 x_initialize (void)
10765 {
10766 struct sigaction action;
10767
10768 baud_rate = 19200;
10769
10770 x_noop_count = 0;
10771 last_tool_bar_item = -1;
10772 any_help_event_p = 0;
10773 ignore_next_mouse_click_timeout = 0;
10774
10775 #ifdef USE_GTK
10776 current_count = -1;
10777 #endif
10778
10779 /* Try to use interrupt input; if we can't, then start polling. */
10780 Fset_input_interrupt_mode (Qt);
10781
10782 #ifdef USE_X_TOOLKIT
10783 XtToolkitInitialize ();
10784
10785 Xt_app_con = XtCreateApplicationContext ();
10786
10787 /* Register a converter from strings to pixels, which uses
10788 Emacs' color allocation infrastructure. */
10789 XtAppSetTypeConverter (Xt_app_con,
10790 XtRString, XtRPixel, cvt_string_to_pixel,
10791 cvt_string_to_pixel_args,
10792 XtNumber (cvt_string_to_pixel_args),
10793 XtCacheByDisplay, cvt_pixel_dtor);
10794
10795 XtAppSetFallbackResources (Xt_app_con, Xt_default_resources);
10796 #endif
10797
10798 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10799 #ifndef USE_GTK
10800 xaw3d_arrow_scroll = False;
10801 xaw3d_pick_top = True;
10802 #endif
10803 #endif
10804
10805 pending_autoraise_frame = 0;
10806 pending_event_wait.f = 0;
10807 pending_event_wait.eventtype = 0;
10808
10809 /* Note that there is no real way portable across R3/R4 to get the
10810 original error handler. */
10811 XSetErrorHandler (x_error_handler);
10812 XSetIOErrorHandler (x_io_error_quitter);
10813
10814 emacs_sigaction_init (&action, x_connection_signal);
10815 sigaction (SIGPIPE, &action, 0);
10816 }
10817
10818
10819 void
10820 syms_of_xterm (void)
10821 {
10822 x_error_message = NULL;
10823
10824 staticpro (&x_display_name_list);
10825 x_display_name_list = Qnil;
10826
10827 staticpro (&last_mouse_scroll_bar);
10828 last_mouse_scroll_bar = Qnil;
10829
10830 DEFSYM (Qvendor_specific_keysyms, "vendor-specific-keysyms");
10831 DEFSYM (Qlatin_1, "latin-1");
10832
10833 staticpro (&last_mouse_press_frame);
10834 last_mouse_press_frame = Qnil;
10835
10836 #ifdef USE_GTK
10837 xg_default_icon_file = build_pure_c_string ("icons/hicolor/scalable/apps/emacs.svg");
10838 staticpro (&xg_default_icon_file);
10839
10840 DEFSYM (Qx_gtk_map_stock, "x-gtk-map-stock");
10841 #endif
10842
10843 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-use-underline-position-properties",
10844 x_use_underline_position_properties,
10845 doc: /* Non-nil means make use of UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties.
10846 A value of nil means ignore them. If you encounter fonts with bogus
10847 UNDERLINE_POSITION font properties, for example 7x13 on XFree prior
10848 to 4.1, set this to nil. You can also use `underline-minimum-offset'
10849 to override the font's UNDERLINE_POSITION for small font display
10850 sizes. */);
10851 x_use_underline_position_properties = 1;
10852
10853 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-underline-at-descent-line",
10854 x_underline_at_descent_line,
10855 doc: /* Non-nil means to draw the underline at the same place as the descent line.
10856 A value of nil means to draw the underline according to the value of the
10857 variable `x-use-underline-position-properties', which is usually at the
10858 baseline level. The default value is nil. */);
10859 x_underline_at_descent_line = 0;
10860
10861 DEFVAR_BOOL ("x-mouse-click-focus-ignore-position",
10862 x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position,
10863 doc: /* Non-nil means that a mouse click to focus a frame does not move point.
10864 This variable is only used when the window manager requires that you
10865 click on a frame to select it (give it focus). In that case, a value
10866 of nil, means that the selected window and cursor position changes to
10867 reflect the mouse click position, while a non-nil value means that the
10868 selected window or cursor position is preserved. */);
10869 x_mouse_click_focus_ignore_position = 0;
10870
10871 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-toolkit-scroll-bars", Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars,
10872 doc: /* Which toolkit scroll bars Emacs uses, if any.
10873 A value of nil means Emacs doesn't use toolkit scroll bars.
10874 With the X Window system, the value is a symbol describing the
10875 X toolkit. Possible values are: gtk, motif, xaw, or xaw3d.
10876 With MS Windows or Nextstep, the value is t. */);
10877 #ifdef USE_TOOLKIT_SCROLL_BARS
10878 #ifdef USE_MOTIF
10879 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("motif");
10880 #elif defined HAVE_XAW3D
10881 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("xaw3d");
10882 #elif USE_GTK
10883 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("gtk");
10884 #else
10885 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = intern_c_string ("xaw");
10886 #endif
10887 #else
10888 Vx_toolkit_scroll_bars = Qnil;
10889 #endif
10890
10891 staticpro (&last_mouse_motion_frame);
10892 last_mouse_motion_frame = Qnil;
10893
10894 Qmodifier_value = intern_c_string ("modifier-value");
10895 Qalt = intern_c_string ("alt");
10896 Fput (Qalt, Qmodifier_value, make_number (alt_modifier));
10897 Qhyper = intern_c_string ("hyper");
10898 Fput (Qhyper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (hyper_modifier));
10899 Qmeta = intern_c_string ("meta");
10900 Fput (Qmeta, Qmodifier_value, make_number (meta_modifier));
10901 Qsuper = intern_c_string ("super");
10902 Fput (Qsuper, Qmodifier_value, make_number (super_modifier));
10903
10904 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-alt-keysym", Vx_alt_keysym,
10905 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the alt modifier.
10906 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10907 For example, `alt' means use the Alt_L and Alt_R keysyms. The default
10908 is nil, which is the same as `alt'. */);
10909 Vx_alt_keysym = Qnil;
10910
10911 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-hyper-keysym", Vx_hyper_keysym,
10912 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the hyper modifier.
10913 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10914 For example, `hyper' means use the Hyper_L and Hyper_R keysyms. The
10915 default is nil, which is the same as `hyper'. */);
10916 Vx_hyper_keysym = Qnil;
10917
10918 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-meta-keysym", Vx_meta_keysym,
10919 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the meta modifier.
10920 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10921 For example, `meta' means use the Meta_L and Meta_R keysyms. The
10922 default is nil, which is the same as `meta'. */);
10923 Vx_meta_keysym = Qnil;
10924
10925 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-super-keysym", Vx_super_keysym,
10926 doc: /* Which keys Emacs uses for the super modifier.
10927 This should be one of the symbols `alt', `hyper', `meta', `super'.
10928 For example, `super' means use the Super_L and Super_R keysyms. The
10929 default is nil, which is the same as `super'. */);
10930 Vx_super_keysym = Qnil;
10931
10932 DEFVAR_LISP ("x-keysym-table", Vx_keysym_table,
10933 doc: /* Hash table of character codes indexed by X keysym codes. */);
10934 Vx_keysym_table = make_hash_table (Qeql, make_number (900),
10935 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_SIZE),
10936 make_float (DEFAULT_REHASH_THRESHOLD),
10937 Qnil, Qnil, Qnil);
10938 }
10939
10940 #endif /* HAVE_X_WINDOWS */